]> git.saurik.com Git - wxWidgets.git/blob - src/generic/grid.cpp
skip the header click event to allow sorting (done in the default handler) to take...
[wxWidgets.git] / src / generic / grid.cpp
1 ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 // Name: src/generic/grid.cpp
3 // Purpose: wxGrid and related classes
4 // Author: Michael Bedward (based on code by Julian Smart, Robin Dunn)
5 // Modified by: Robin Dunn, Vadim Zeitlin, Santiago Palacios
6 // Created: 1/08/1999
7 // RCS-ID: $Id$
8 // Copyright: (c) Michael Bedward (mbedward@ozemail.com.au)
9 // Licence: wxWindows licence
10 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 /*
13 TODO:
14
15 - Replace use of wxINVERT with wxOverlay
16 - Make Begin/EndBatch() the same as the generic Freeze/Thaw()
17 - Review the column reordering code, it's a mess.
18 - Implement row reordering after dealing with the columns.
19 */
20
21 // For compilers that support precompilation, includes "wx/wx.h".
22 #include "wx/wxprec.h"
23
24 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
25 #pragma hdrstop
26 #endif
27
28 #if wxUSE_GRID
29
30 #include "wx/grid.h"
31
32 #ifndef WX_PRECOMP
33 #include "wx/utils.h"
34 #include "wx/dcclient.h"
35 #include "wx/settings.h"
36 #include "wx/log.h"
37 #include "wx/textctrl.h"
38 #include "wx/checkbox.h"
39 #include "wx/combobox.h"
40 #include "wx/valtext.h"
41 #include "wx/intl.h"
42 #include "wx/math.h"
43 #include "wx/listbox.h"
44 #endif
45
46 #include "wx/textfile.h"
47 #include "wx/spinctrl.h"
48 #include "wx/tokenzr.h"
49 #include "wx/renderer.h"
50
51 #include "wx/generic/gridsel.h"
52
53 const char wxGridNameStr[] = "grid";
54
55 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
56 #define WXUNUSED_MOTIF(identifier) WXUNUSED(identifier)
57 #else
58 #define WXUNUSED_MOTIF(identifier) identifier
59 #endif
60
61 #if defined(__WXGTK__)
62 #define WXUNUSED_GTK(identifier) WXUNUSED(identifier)
63 #else
64 #define WXUNUSED_GTK(identifier) identifier
65 #endif
66
67 // Required for wxIs... functions
68 #include <ctype.h>
69
70 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
71 // array classes
72 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
73
74 WX_DEFINE_ARRAY_WITH_DECL_PTR(wxGridCellAttr *, wxArrayAttrs,
75 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
76
77 struct wxGridCellWithAttr
78 {
79 wxGridCellWithAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr_)
80 : coords(row, col), attr(attr_)
81 {
82 wxASSERT( attr );
83 }
84
85 wxGridCellWithAttr(const wxGridCellWithAttr& other)
86 : coords(other.coords),
87 attr(other.attr)
88 {
89 attr->IncRef();
90 }
91
92 wxGridCellWithAttr& operator=(const wxGridCellWithAttr& other)
93 {
94 coords = other.coords;
95 if (attr != other.attr)
96 {
97 attr->DecRef();
98 attr = other.attr;
99 attr->IncRef();
100 }
101 return *this;
102 }
103
104 void ChangeAttr(wxGridCellAttr* new_attr)
105 {
106 if (attr != new_attr)
107 {
108 // "Delete" (i.e. DecRef) the old attribute.
109 attr->DecRef();
110 attr = new_attr;
111 // Take ownership of the new attribute, i.e. no IncRef.
112 }
113 }
114
115 ~wxGridCellWithAttr()
116 {
117 attr->DecRef();
118 }
119
120 wxGridCellCoords coords;
121 wxGridCellAttr *attr;
122 };
123
124 WX_DECLARE_OBJARRAY_WITH_DECL(wxGridCellWithAttr, wxGridCellWithAttrArray,
125 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
126
127 #include "wx/arrimpl.cpp"
128
129 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridCellCoordsArray)
130 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridCellWithAttrArray)
131
132 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
133 // events
134 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
135
136 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_CLICK)
137 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_CLICK)
138 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_DCLICK)
139 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_DCLICK)
140 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_BEGIN_DRAG)
141 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK)
142 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK)
143 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK)
144 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK)
145 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE)
146 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE)
147 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_COL_MOVE)
148 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_RANGE_SELECT)
149 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE)
150 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_SELECT_CELL)
151 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_SHOWN)
152 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_HIDDEN)
153 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_CREATED)
154
155 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
156 // private classes
157 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
158
159 // common base class for various grid subwindows
160 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridSubwindow : public wxWindow
161 {
162 public:
163 wxGridSubwindow() { m_owner = NULL; }
164 wxGridSubwindow(wxGrid *owner,
165 wxWindowID id,
166 const wxPoint& pos,
167 const wxSize& size,
168 int additionalStyle = 0,
169 const wxString& name = wxPanelNameStr)
170 : wxWindow(owner, id, pos, size,
171 wxBORDER_NONE | additionalStyle,
172 name)
173 {
174 m_owner = owner;
175 }
176
177 virtual bool AcceptsFocus() const { return false; }
178
179 wxGrid *GetOwner() { return m_owner; }
180
181 protected:
182 void OnMouseCaptureLost(wxMouseCaptureLostEvent& event);
183
184 wxGrid *m_owner;
185
186 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
187 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridSubwindow)
188 };
189
190 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridRowLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
191 {
192 public:
193 wxGridRowLabelWindow() { }
194 wxGridRowLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
195 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
196
197 private:
198 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
199 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
200 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
201
202 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridRowLabelWindow)
203 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
204 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridRowLabelWindow)
205 };
206
207
208 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridColLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
209 {
210 public:
211 wxGridColLabelWindow() { }
212 wxGridColLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
213 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
214
215 private:
216 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
217 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
218 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
219
220 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridColLabelWindow)
221 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
222 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridColLabelWindow)
223 };
224
225
226 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCornerLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
227 {
228 public:
229 wxGridCornerLabelWindow() { }
230 wxGridCornerLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
231 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
232
233 private:
234 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
235 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
236 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
237
238 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridCornerLabelWindow)
239 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
240 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridCornerLabelWindow)
241 };
242
243 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
244 {
245 public:
246 wxGridWindow()
247 {
248 m_rowLabelWin = NULL;
249 m_colLabelWin = NULL;
250 }
251
252 wxGridWindow( wxGrid *parent,
253 wxGridRowLabelWindow *rowLblWin,
254 wxGridColLabelWindow *colLblWin,
255 wxWindowID id, const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
256
257 void ScrollWindow( int dx, int dy, const wxRect *rect );
258
259 virtual bool AcceptsFocus() const { return true; }
260
261 private:
262 wxGridRowLabelWindow *m_rowLabelWin;
263 wxGridColLabelWindow *m_colLabelWin;
264
265 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent &event );
266 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
267 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
268 void OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& );
269 void OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& );
270 void OnChar( wxKeyEvent& );
271 void OnEraseBackground( wxEraseEvent& );
272 void OnFocus( wxFocusEvent& );
273
274 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridWindow)
275 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
276 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridWindow)
277 };
278
279
280 class wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler : public wxEvtHandler
281 {
282 public:
283 wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler(wxGrid* grid, wxGridCellEditor* editor)
284 : m_grid(grid),
285 m_editor(editor),
286 m_inSetFocus(false)
287 {
288 }
289
290 void OnKillFocus(wxFocusEvent& event);
291 void OnKeyDown(wxKeyEvent& event);
292 void OnChar(wxKeyEvent& event);
293
294 void SetInSetFocus(bool inSetFocus) { m_inSetFocus = inSetFocus; }
295
296 private:
297 wxGrid *m_grid;
298 wxGridCellEditor *m_editor;
299
300 // Work around the fact that a focus kill event can be sent to
301 // a combobox within a set focus event.
302 bool m_inSetFocus;
303
304 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
305 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler)
306 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler)
307 };
308
309
310 IMPLEMENT_ABSTRACT_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler, wxEvtHandler)
311
312 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler, wxEvtHandler )
313 EVT_KILL_FOCUS( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKillFocus )
314 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKeyDown )
315 EVT_CHAR( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnChar )
316 END_EVENT_TABLE()
317
318
319 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
320 // the internal data representation used by wxGridCellAttrProvider
321 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
322
323 // this class stores attributes set for cells
324 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCellAttrData
325 {
326 public:
327 void SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row, int col);
328 wxGridCellAttr *GetAttr(int row, int col) const;
329 void UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows );
330 void UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols );
331
332 private:
333 // searches for the attr for given cell, returns wxNOT_FOUND if not found
334 int FindIndex(int row, int col) const;
335
336 wxGridCellWithAttrArray m_attrs;
337 };
338
339 // this class stores attributes set for rows or columns
340 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridRowOrColAttrData
341 {
342 public:
343 // empty ctor to suppress warnings
344 wxGridRowOrColAttrData() {}
345 ~wxGridRowOrColAttrData();
346
347 void SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int rowOrCol);
348 wxGridCellAttr *GetAttr(int rowOrCol) const;
349 void UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( size_t pos, int numRowsOrCols );
350
351 private:
352 wxArrayInt m_rowsOrCols;
353 wxArrayAttrs m_attrs;
354 };
355
356 // NB: this is just a wrapper around 3 objects: one which stores cell
357 // attributes, and 2 others for row/col ones
358 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCellAttrProviderData
359 {
360 public:
361 wxGridCellAttrData m_cellAttrs;
362 wxGridRowOrColAttrData m_rowAttrs,
363 m_colAttrs;
364 };
365
366
367 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
368 // data structures used for the data type registry
369 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
370
371 struct wxGridDataTypeInfo
372 {
373 wxGridDataTypeInfo(const wxString& typeName,
374 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
375 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
376 : m_typeName(typeName), m_renderer(renderer), m_editor(editor)
377 {}
378
379 ~wxGridDataTypeInfo()
380 {
381 wxSafeDecRef(m_renderer);
382 wxSafeDecRef(m_editor);
383 }
384
385 wxString m_typeName;
386 wxGridCellRenderer* m_renderer;
387 wxGridCellEditor* m_editor;
388
389 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridDataTypeInfo)
390 };
391
392
393 WX_DEFINE_ARRAY_WITH_DECL_PTR(wxGridDataTypeInfo*, wxGridDataTypeInfoArray,
394 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
395
396
397 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridTypeRegistry
398 {
399 public:
400 wxGridTypeRegistry() {}
401 ~wxGridTypeRegistry();
402
403 void RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
404 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
405 wxGridCellEditor* editor);
406
407 // find one of already registered data types
408 int FindRegisteredDataType(const wxString& typeName);
409
410 // try to FindRegisteredDataType(), if this fails and typeName is one of
411 // standard typenames, register it and return its index
412 int FindDataType(const wxString& typeName);
413
414 // try to FindDataType(), if it fails see if it is not one of already
415 // registered data types with some params in which case clone the
416 // registered data type and set params for it
417 int FindOrCloneDataType(const wxString& typeName);
418
419 wxGridCellRenderer* GetRenderer(int index);
420 wxGridCellEditor* GetEditor(int index);
421
422 private:
423 wxGridDataTypeInfoArray m_typeinfo;
424 };
425
426 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
427 // operations classes abstracting the difference between operating on rows and
428 // columns
429 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
430
431 // This class allows to write a function only once because by using its methods
432 // it will apply to both columns and rows.
433 //
434 // This is an abstract interface definition, the two concrete implementations
435 // below should be used when working with rows and columns respectively.
436 class wxGridOperations
437 {
438 public:
439 // Returns the operations in the other direction, i.e. wxGridRowOperations
440 // if this object is a wxGridColumnOperations and vice versa.
441 virtual wxGridOperations& Dual() const = 0;
442
443 // Return the number of rows or columns.
444 virtual int GetNumberOfLines(const wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
445
446 // Return the selection mode which allows selecting rows or columns.
447 virtual wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes GetSelectionMode() const = 0;
448
449 // Make a wxGridCellCoords from the given components: thisDir is row or
450 // column and otherDir is column or row
451 virtual wxGridCellCoords MakeCoords(int thisDir, int otherDir) const = 0;
452
453 // Calculate the scrolled position of the given abscissa or ordinate.
454 virtual int CalcScrolledPosition(wxGrid *grid, int pos) const = 0;
455
456 // Selects the horizontal or vertical component from the given object.
457 virtual int Select(const wxGridCellCoords& coords) const = 0;
458 virtual int Select(const wxPoint& pt) const = 0;
459 virtual int Select(const wxSize& sz) const = 0;
460 virtual int Select(const wxRect& r) const = 0;
461 virtual int& Select(wxRect& r) const = 0;
462
463 // Returns width or height of the rectangle
464 virtual int& SelectSize(wxRect& r) const = 0;
465
466 // Make a wxSize such that Select() applied to it returns first component
467 virtual wxSize MakeSize(int first, int second) const = 0;
468
469 // Sets the row or column component of the given cell coordinates
470 virtual void Set(wxGridCellCoords& coords, int line) const = 0;
471
472
473 // Draws a line parallel to the row or column, i.e. horizontal or vertical:
474 // pos is the horizontal or vertical position of the line and start and end
475 // are the coordinates of the line extremities in the other direction
476 virtual void
477 DrawParallelLine(wxDC& dc, int start, int end, int pos) const = 0;
478
479 // Draw a horizontal or vertical line across the given rectangle
480 // (this is implemented in terms of above and uses Select() to extract
481 // start and end from the given rectangle)
482 void DrawParallelLineInRect(wxDC& dc, const wxRect& rect, int pos) const
483 {
484 const int posStart = Select(rect.GetPosition());
485 DrawParallelLine(dc, posStart, posStart + Select(rect.GetSize()), pos);
486 }
487
488
489 // Return the row or column at the given pixel coordinate.
490 virtual int
491 PosToLine(const wxGrid *grid, int pos, bool clip = false) const = 0;
492
493 // Get the top/left position, in pixels, of the given row or column
494 virtual int GetLineStartPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const = 0;
495
496 // Get the bottom/right position, in pixels, of the given row or column
497 virtual int GetLineEndPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const = 0;
498
499 // Get the height/width of the given row/column
500 virtual int GetLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const = 0;
501
502 // Get wxGrid::m_rowBottoms/m_colRights array
503 virtual const wxArrayInt& GetLineEnds(const wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
504
505 // Get default height row height or column width
506 virtual int GetDefaultLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
507
508 // Return the minimal acceptable row height or column width
509 virtual int GetMinimalAcceptableLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
510
511 // Return the minimal row height or column width
512 virtual int GetMinimalLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const = 0;
513
514 // Set the row height or column width
515 virtual void SetLineSize(wxGrid *grid, int line, int size) const = 0;
516
517 // True if rows/columns can be resized by user
518 virtual bool CanResizeLines(const wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
519
520
521 // Return the index of the line at the given position
522 //
523 // NB: currently this is always identity for the rows as reordering is only
524 // implemented for the lines
525 virtual int GetLineAt(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const = 0;
526
527
528 // Get the row or column label window
529 virtual wxWindow *GetHeaderWindow(wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
530
531 // Get the width or height of the row or column label window
532 virtual int GetHeaderWindowSize(wxGrid *grid) const = 0;
533
534
535 // This class is never used polymorphically but give it a virtual dtor
536 // anyhow to suppress g++ complaints about it
537 virtual ~wxGridOperations() { }
538 };
539
540 class wxGridRowOperations : public wxGridOperations
541 {
542 public:
543 virtual wxGridOperations& Dual() const;
544
545 virtual int GetNumberOfLines(const wxGrid *grid) const
546 { return grid->GetNumberRows(); }
547
548 virtual wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes GetSelectionMode() const
549 { return wxGrid::wxGridSelectRows; }
550
551 virtual wxGridCellCoords MakeCoords(int thisDir, int otherDir) const
552 { return wxGridCellCoords(thisDir, otherDir); }
553
554 virtual int CalcScrolledPosition(wxGrid *grid, int pos) const
555 { return grid->CalcScrolledPosition(wxPoint(pos, 0)).x; }
556
557 virtual int Select(const wxGridCellCoords& c) const { return c.GetRow(); }
558 virtual int Select(const wxPoint& pt) const { return pt.x; }
559 virtual int Select(const wxSize& sz) const { return sz.x; }
560 virtual int Select(const wxRect& r) const { return r.x; }
561 virtual int& Select(wxRect& r) const { return r.x; }
562 virtual int& SelectSize(wxRect& r) const { return r.width; }
563 virtual wxSize MakeSize(int first, int second) const
564 { return wxSize(first, second); }
565 virtual void Set(wxGridCellCoords& coords, int line) const
566 { coords.SetRow(line); }
567
568 virtual void DrawParallelLine(wxDC& dc, int start, int end, int pos) const
569 { dc.DrawLine(start, pos, end, pos); }
570
571 virtual int PosToLine(const wxGrid *grid, int pos, bool clip = false) const
572 { return grid->YToRow(pos, clip); }
573 virtual int GetLineStartPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
574 { return grid->GetRowTop(line); }
575 virtual int GetLineEndPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
576 { return grid->GetRowBottom(line); }
577 virtual int GetLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
578 { return grid->GetRowHeight(line); }
579 virtual const wxArrayInt& GetLineEnds(const wxGrid *grid) const
580 { return grid->m_rowBottoms; }
581 virtual int GetDefaultLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const
582 { return grid->GetDefaultRowSize(); }
583 virtual int GetMinimalAcceptableLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const
584 { return grid->GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight(); }
585 virtual int GetMinimalLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
586 { return grid->GetRowMinimalHeight(line); }
587 virtual void SetLineSize(wxGrid *grid, int line, int size) const
588 { grid->SetRowSize(line, size); }
589 virtual bool CanResizeLines(const wxGrid *grid) const
590 { return grid->CanDragRowSize(); }
591
592 virtual int GetLineAt(const wxGrid * WXUNUSED(grid), int line) const
593 { return line; } // TODO: implement row reordering
594
595 virtual wxWindow *GetHeaderWindow(wxGrid *grid) const
596 { return grid->GetGridRowLabelWindow(); }
597 virtual int GetHeaderWindowSize(wxGrid *grid) const
598 { return grid->GetRowLabelSize(); }
599 };
600
601 class wxGridColumnOperations : public wxGridOperations
602 {
603 public:
604 virtual wxGridOperations& Dual() const;
605
606 virtual int GetNumberOfLines(const wxGrid *grid) const
607 { return grid->GetNumberCols(); }
608
609 virtual wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes GetSelectionMode() const
610 { return wxGrid::wxGridSelectColumns; }
611
612 virtual wxGridCellCoords MakeCoords(int thisDir, int otherDir) const
613 { return wxGridCellCoords(otherDir, thisDir); }
614
615 virtual int CalcScrolledPosition(wxGrid *grid, int pos) const
616 { return grid->CalcScrolledPosition(wxPoint(0, pos)).y; }
617
618 virtual int Select(const wxGridCellCoords& c) const { return c.GetCol(); }
619 virtual int Select(const wxPoint& pt) const { return pt.y; }
620 virtual int Select(const wxSize& sz) const { return sz.y; }
621 virtual int Select(const wxRect& r) const { return r.y; }
622 virtual int& Select(wxRect& r) const { return r.y; }
623 virtual int& SelectSize(wxRect& r) const { return r.height; }
624 virtual wxSize MakeSize(int first, int second) const
625 { return wxSize(second, first); }
626 virtual void Set(wxGridCellCoords& coords, int line) const
627 { coords.SetCol(line); }
628
629 virtual void DrawParallelLine(wxDC& dc, int start, int end, int pos) const
630 { dc.DrawLine(pos, start, pos, end); }
631
632 virtual int PosToLine(const wxGrid *grid, int pos, bool clip = false) const
633 { return grid->XToCol(pos, clip); }
634 virtual int GetLineStartPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
635 { return grid->GetColLeft(line); }
636 virtual int GetLineEndPos(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
637 { return grid->GetColRight(line); }
638 virtual int GetLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
639 { return grid->GetColWidth(line); }
640 virtual const wxArrayInt& GetLineEnds(const wxGrid *grid) const
641 { return grid->m_colRights; }
642 virtual int GetDefaultLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const
643 { return grid->GetDefaultColSize(); }
644 virtual int GetMinimalAcceptableLineSize(const wxGrid *grid) const
645 { return grid->GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth(); }
646 virtual int GetMinimalLineSize(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
647 { return grid->GetColMinimalWidth(line); }
648 virtual void SetLineSize(wxGrid *grid, int line, int size) const
649 { grid->SetColSize(line, size); }
650 virtual bool CanResizeLines(const wxGrid *grid) const
651 { return grid->CanDragColSize(); }
652
653 virtual int GetLineAt(const wxGrid *grid, int line) const
654 { return grid->GetColAt(line); }
655
656 virtual wxWindow *GetHeaderWindow(wxGrid *grid) const
657 { return grid->GetGridColLabelWindow(); }
658 virtual int GetHeaderWindowSize(wxGrid *grid) const
659 { return grid->GetColLabelSize(); }
660 };
661
662 wxGridOperations& wxGridRowOperations::Dual() const
663 {
664 static wxGridColumnOperations s_colOper;
665
666 return s_colOper;
667 }
668
669 wxGridOperations& wxGridColumnOperations::Dual() const
670 {
671 static wxGridRowOperations s_rowOper;
672
673 return s_rowOper;
674 }
675
676 // This class abstracts the difference between operations going forward
677 // (down/right) and backward (up/left) and allows to use the same code for
678 // functions which differ only in the direction of grid traversal
679 //
680 // Like wxGridOperations it's an ABC with two concrete subclasses below. Unlike
681 // it, this is a normal object and not just a function dispatch table and has a
682 // non-default ctor.
683 //
684 // Note: the explanation of this discrepancy is the existence of (very useful)
685 // Dual() method in wxGridOperations which forces us to make wxGridOperations a
686 // function dispatcher only.
687 class wxGridDirectionOperations
688 {
689 public:
690 // The oper parameter to ctor selects whether we work with rows or columns
691 wxGridDirectionOperations(wxGrid *grid, const wxGridOperations& oper)
692 : m_grid(grid),
693 m_oper(oper)
694 {
695 }
696
697 // Check if the component of this point in our direction is at the
698 // boundary, i.e. is the first/last row/column
699 virtual bool IsAtBoundary(const wxGridCellCoords& coords) const = 0;
700
701 // Increment the component of this point in our direction
702 virtual void Advance(wxGridCellCoords& coords) const = 0;
703
704 // Find the line at the given distance, in pixels, away from this one
705 // (this uses clipping, i.e. anything after the last line is counted as the
706 // last one and anything before the first one as 0)
707 virtual int MoveByPixelDistance(int line, int distance) const = 0;
708
709 // This class is never used polymorphically but give it a virtual dtor
710 // anyhow to suppress g++ complaints about it
711 virtual ~wxGridDirectionOperations() { }
712
713 protected:
714 wxGrid * const m_grid;
715 const wxGridOperations& m_oper;
716 };
717
718 class wxGridBackwardOperations : public wxGridDirectionOperations
719 {
720 public:
721 wxGridBackwardOperations(wxGrid *grid, const wxGridOperations& oper)
722 : wxGridDirectionOperations(grid, oper)
723 {
724 }
725
726 virtual bool IsAtBoundary(const wxGridCellCoords& coords) const
727 {
728 wxASSERT_MSG( m_oper.Select(coords) >= 0, "invalid row/column" );
729
730 return m_oper.Select(coords) == 0;
731 }
732
733 virtual void Advance(wxGridCellCoords& coords) const
734 {
735 wxASSERT( !IsAtBoundary(coords) );
736
737 m_oper.Set(coords, m_oper.Select(coords) - 1);
738 }
739
740 virtual int MoveByPixelDistance(int line, int distance) const
741 {
742 int pos = m_oper.GetLineStartPos(m_grid, line);
743 return m_oper.PosToLine(m_grid, pos - distance + 1, true);
744 }
745 };
746
747 class wxGridForwardOperations : public wxGridDirectionOperations
748 {
749 public:
750 wxGridForwardOperations(wxGrid *grid, const wxGridOperations& oper)
751 : wxGridDirectionOperations(grid, oper),
752 m_numLines(oper.GetNumberOfLines(grid))
753 {
754 }
755
756 virtual bool IsAtBoundary(const wxGridCellCoords& coords) const
757 {
758 wxASSERT_MSG( m_oper.Select(coords) < m_numLines, "invalid row/column" );
759
760 return m_oper.Select(coords) == m_numLines - 1;
761 }
762
763 virtual void Advance(wxGridCellCoords& coords) const
764 {
765 wxASSERT( !IsAtBoundary(coords) );
766
767 m_oper.Set(coords, m_oper.Select(coords) + 1);
768 }
769
770 virtual int MoveByPixelDistance(int line, int distance) const
771 {
772 int pos = m_oper.GetLineStartPos(m_grid, line);
773 return m_oper.PosToLine(m_grid, pos + distance, true);
774 }
775
776 private:
777 const int m_numLines;
778 };
779
780 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
781 // globals
782 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
783
784 //#define DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
785 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
786 static size_t gs_nAttrCacheHits = 0;
787 static size_t gs_nAttrCacheMisses = 0;
788 #endif
789
790 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
791 // constants
792 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
793
794 wxGridCellCoords wxGridNoCellCoords( -1, -1 );
795 wxRect wxGridNoCellRect( -1, -1, -1, -1 );
796
797 namespace
798 {
799
800 // scroll line size
801 const size_t GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X = 15;
802 const size_t GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X;
803
804 // the size of hash tables used a bit everywhere (the max number of elements
805 // in these hash tables is the number of rows/columns)
806 const int GRID_HASH_SIZE = 100;
807
808 // the minimal distance in pixels the mouse needs to move to start a drag
809 // operation
810 const int DRAG_SENSITIVITY = 3;
811
812 } // anonymous namespace
813
814 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
815 // private helpers
816 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
817
818 namespace
819 {
820
821 // ensure that first is less or equal to second, swapping the values if
822 // necessary
823 void EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(int& first, int& second)
824 {
825 if ( first > second )
826 wxSwap(first, second);
827 }
828
829 } // anonymous namespace
830
831 // ============================================================================
832 // implementation
833 // ============================================================================
834
835 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
836 // wxGridCellEditor
837 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
838
839 wxGridCellEditor::wxGridCellEditor()
840 {
841 m_control = NULL;
842 m_attr = NULL;
843 }
844
845 wxGridCellEditor::~wxGridCellEditor()
846 {
847 Destroy();
848 }
849
850 void wxGridCellEditor::Create(wxWindow* WXUNUSED(parent),
851 wxWindowID WXUNUSED(id),
852 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
853 {
854 if ( evtHandler )
855 m_control->PushEventHandler(evtHandler);
856 }
857
858 void wxGridCellEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& rectCell,
859 wxGridCellAttr *attr)
860 {
861 // erase the background because we might not fill the cell
862 wxClientDC dc(m_control->GetParent());
863 wxGridWindow* gridWindow = wxDynamicCast(m_control->GetParent(), wxGridWindow);
864 if (gridWindow)
865 gridWindow->GetOwner()->PrepareDC(dc);
866
867 dc.SetPen(*wxTRANSPARENT_PEN);
868 dc.SetBrush(wxBrush(attr->GetBackgroundColour()));
869 dc.DrawRectangle(rectCell);
870
871 // redraw the control we just painted over
872 m_control->Refresh();
873 }
874
875 void wxGridCellEditor::Destroy()
876 {
877 if (m_control)
878 {
879 m_control->PopEventHandler( true /* delete it*/ );
880
881 m_control->Destroy();
882 m_control = NULL;
883 }
884 }
885
886 void wxGridCellEditor::Show(bool show, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
887 {
888 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
889
890 m_control->Show(show);
891
892 if ( show )
893 {
894 // set the colours/fonts if we have any
895 if ( attr )
896 {
897 m_colFgOld = m_control->GetForegroundColour();
898 m_control->SetForegroundColour(attr->GetTextColour());
899
900 m_colBgOld = m_control->GetBackgroundColour();
901 m_control->SetBackgroundColour(attr->GetBackgroundColour());
902
903 // Workaround for GTK+1 font setting problem on some platforms
904 #if !defined(__WXGTK__) || defined(__WXGTK20__)
905 m_fontOld = m_control->GetFont();
906 m_control->SetFont(attr->GetFont());
907 #endif
908
909 // can't do anything more in the base class version, the other
910 // attributes may only be used by the derived classes
911 }
912 }
913 else
914 {
915 // restore the standard colours fonts
916 if ( m_colFgOld.Ok() )
917 {
918 m_control->SetForegroundColour(m_colFgOld);
919 m_colFgOld = wxNullColour;
920 }
921
922 if ( m_colBgOld.Ok() )
923 {
924 m_control->SetBackgroundColour(m_colBgOld);
925 m_colBgOld = wxNullColour;
926 }
927
928 // Workaround for GTK+1 font setting problem on some platforms
929 #if !defined(__WXGTK__) || defined(__WXGTK20__)
930 if ( m_fontOld.Ok() )
931 {
932 m_control->SetFont(m_fontOld);
933 m_fontOld = wxNullFont;
934 }
935 #endif
936 }
937 }
938
939 void wxGridCellEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& rect)
940 {
941 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
942
943 m_control->SetSize(rect, wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE);
944 }
945
946 void wxGridCellEditor::HandleReturn(wxKeyEvent& event)
947 {
948 event.Skip();
949 }
950
951 bool wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
952 {
953 bool ctrl = event.ControlDown();
954 bool alt = event.AltDown();
955
956 #ifdef __WXMAC__
957 // On the Mac the Alt key is more like shift and is used for entry of
958 // valid characters, so check for Ctrl and Meta instead.
959 alt = event.MetaDown();
960 #endif
961
962 // Assume it's not a valid char if ctrl or alt is down, but if both are
963 // down then it may be because of an AltGr key combination, so let them
964 // through in that case.
965 if ((ctrl || alt) && !(ctrl && alt))
966 return false;
967
968 #if wxUSE_UNICODE
969 // if the unicode key code is not really a unicode character (it may
970 // be a function key or etc., the platforms appear to always give us a
971 // small value in this case) then fallback to the ASCII key code but
972 // don't do anything for function keys or etc.
973 if ( event.GetUnicodeKey() > 127 && event.GetKeyCode() > 127 )
974 return false;
975 #else
976 if ( event.GetKeyCode() > 255 )
977 return false;
978 #endif
979
980 return true;
981 }
982
983 void wxGridCellEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
984 {
985 event.Skip();
986 }
987
988 void wxGridCellEditor::StartingClick()
989 {
990 }
991
992 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
993
994 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
995 // wxGridCellTextEditor
996 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
997
998 wxGridCellTextEditor::wxGridCellTextEditor()
999 {
1000 m_maxChars = 0;
1001 }
1002
1003 void wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1004 wxWindowID id,
1005 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1006 {
1007 DoCreate(parent, id, evtHandler);
1008 }
1009
1010 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoCreate(wxWindow* parent,
1011 wxWindowID id,
1012 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler,
1013 long style)
1014 {
1015 style |= wxTE_PROCESS_ENTER | wxTE_PROCESS_TAB | wxNO_BORDER;
1016
1017 m_control = new wxTextCtrl(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
1018 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1019 style);
1020
1021 // set max length allowed in the textctrl, if the parameter was set
1022 if ( m_maxChars != 0 )
1023 {
1024 Text()->SetMaxLength(m_maxChars);
1025 }
1026
1027 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1028 }
1029
1030 void wxGridCellTextEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& WXUNUSED(rectCell),
1031 wxGridCellAttr * WXUNUSED(attr))
1032 {
1033 // as we fill the entire client area,
1034 // don't do anything here to minimize flicker
1035 }
1036
1037 void wxGridCellTextEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& rectOrig)
1038 {
1039 wxRect rect(rectOrig);
1040
1041 // Make the edit control large enough to allow for internal margins
1042 //
1043 // TODO: remove this if the text ctrl sizing is improved esp. for unix
1044 //
1045 #if defined(__WXGTK__)
1046 if (rect.x != 0)
1047 {
1048 rect.x += 1;
1049 rect.y += 1;
1050 rect.width -= 1;
1051 rect.height -= 1;
1052 }
1053 #elif defined(__WXMSW__)
1054 if ( rect.x == 0 )
1055 rect.x += 2;
1056 else
1057 rect.x += 3;
1058
1059 if ( rect.y == 0 )
1060 rect.y += 2;
1061 else
1062 rect.y += 3;
1063
1064 rect.width -= 2;
1065 rect.height -= 2;
1066 #else
1067 int extra_x = ( rect.x > 2 ) ? 2 : 1;
1068 int extra_y = ( rect.y > 2 ) ? 2 : 1;
1069
1070 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
1071 extra_x *= 2;
1072 extra_y *= 2;
1073 #endif
1074
1075 rect.SetLeft( wxMax(0, rect.x - extra_x) );
1076 rect.SetTop( wxMax(0, rect.y - extra_y) );
1077 rect.SetRight( rect.GetRight() + 2 * extra_x );
1078 rect.SetBottom( rect.GetBottom() + 2 * extra_y );
1079 #endif
1080
1081 wxGridCellEditor::SetSize(rect);
1082 }
1083
1084 void wxGridCellTextEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1085 {
1086 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1087
1088 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col);
1089
1090 DoBeginEdit(m_startValue);
1091 }
1092
1093 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoBeginEdit(const wxString& startValue)
1094 {
1095 Text()->SetValue(startValue);
1096 Text()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
1097 Text()->SetSelection(-1, -1);
1098 Text()->SetFocus();
1099 }
1100
1101 bool wxGridCellTextEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1102 {
1103 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1104
1105 bool changed = false;
1106 wxString value = Text()->GetValue();
1107 if (value != m_startValue)
1108 changed = true;
1109
1110 if (changed)
1111 grid->GetTable()->SetValue(row, col, value);
1112
1113 m_startValue = wxEmptyString;
1114
1115 // No point in setting the text of the hidden control
1116 //Text()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1117
1118 return changed;
1119 }
1120
1121 void wxGridCellTextEditor::Reset()
1122 {
1123 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1124
1125 DoReset(m_startValue);
1126 }
1127
1128 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoReset(const wxString& startValue)
1129 {
1130 Text()->SetValue(startValue);
1131 Text()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
1132 }
1133
1134 bool wxGridCellTextEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1135 {
1136 return wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event);
1137 }
1138
1139 void wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1140 {
1141 // Since this is now happening in the EVT_CHAR event EmulateKeyPress is no
1142 // longer an appropriate way to get the character into the text control.
1143 // Do it ourselves instead. We know that if we get this far that we have
1144 // a valid character, so not a whole lot of testing needs to be done.
1145
1146 wxTextCtrl* tc = Text();
1147 wxChar ch;
1148 long pos;
1149
1150 #if wxUSE_UNICODE
1151 ch = event.GetUnicodeKey();
1152 if (ch <= 127)
1153 ch = (wxChar)event.GetKeyCode();
1154 #else
1155 ch = (wxChar)event.GetKeyCode();
1156 #endif
1157
1158 switch (ch)
1159 {
1160 case WXK_DELETE:
1161 // delete the character at the cursor
1162 pos = tc->GetInsertionPoint();
1163 if (pos < tc->GetLastPosition())
1164 tc->Remove(pos, pos + 1);
1165 break;
1166
1167 case WXK_BACK:
1168 // delete the character before the cursor
1169 pos = tc->GetInsertionPoint();
1170 if (pos > 0)
1171 tc->Remove(pos - 1, pos);
1172 break;
1173
1174 default:
1175 tc->WriteText(ch);
1176 break;
1177 }
1178 }
1179
1180 void wxGridCellTextEditor::HandleReturn( wxKeyEvent&
1181 WXUNUSED_GTK(WXUNUSED_MOTIF(event)) )
1182 {
1183 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__) || defined(__WXGTK__)
1184 // wxMotif needs a little extra help...
1185 size_t pos = (size_t)( Text()->GetInsertionPoint() );
1186 wxString s( Text()->GetValue() );
1187 s = s.Left(pos) + wxT("\n") + s.Mid(pos);
1188 Text()->SetValue(s);
1189 Text()->SetInsertionPoint( pos );
1190 #else
1191 // the other ports can handle a Return key press
1192 //
1193 event.Skip();
1194 #endif
1195 }
1196
1197 void wxGridCellTextEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1198 {
1199 if ( !params )
1200 {
1201 // reset to default
1202 m_maxChars = 0;
1203 }
1204 else
1205 {
1206 long tmp;
1207 if ( params.ToLong(&tmp) )
1208 {
1209 m_maxChars = (size_t)tmp;
1210 }
1211 else
1212 {
1213 wxLogDebug( _T("Invalid wxGridCellTextEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str() );
1214 }
1215 }
1216 }
1217
1218 // return the value in the text control
1219 wxString wxGridCellTextEditor::GetValue() const
1220 {
1221 return Text()->GetValue();
1222 }
1223
1224 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1225 // wxGridCellNumberEditor
1226 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1227
1228 wxGridCellNumberEditor::wxGridCellNumberEditor(int min, int max)
1229 {
1230 m_min = min;
1231 m_max = max;
1232 }
1233
1234 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1235 wxWindowID id,
1236 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1237 {
1238 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1239 if ( HasRange() )
1240 {
1241 // create a spin ctrl
1242 m_control = new wxSpinCtrl(parent, wxID_ANY, wxEmptyString,
1243 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1244 wxSP_ARROW_KEYS,
1245 m_min, m_max);
1246
1247 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1248 }
1249 else
1250 #endif
1251 {
1252 // just a text control
1253 wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1254
1255 #if wxUSE_VALIDATORS
1256 Text()->SetValidator(wxTextValidator(wxFILTER_NUMERIC));
1257 #endif
1258 }
1259 }
1260
1261 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1262 {
1263 // first get the value
1264 wxGridTableBase *table = grid->GetTable();
1265 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
1266 {
1267 m_valueOld = table->GetValueAsLong(row, col);
1268 }
1269 else
1270 {
1271 m_valueOld = 0;
1272 wxString sValue = table->GetValue(row, col);
1273 if (! sValue.ToLong(&m_valueOld) && ! sValue.empty())
1274 {
1275 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("this cell doesn't have numeric value") );
1276 return;
1277 }
1278 }
1279
1280 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1281 if ( HasRange() )
1282 {
1283 Spin()->SetValue((int)m_valueOld);
1284 Spin()->SetFocus();
1285 }
1286 else
1287 #endif
1288 {
1289 DoBeginEdit(GetString());
1290 }
1291 }
1292
1293 bool wxGridCellNumberEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
1294 wxGrid* grid)
1295 {
1296 long value = 0;
1297 wxString text;
1298
1299 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1300 if ( HasRange() )
1301 {
1302 value = Spin()->GetValue();
1303 if ( value == m_valueOld )
1304 return false;
1305
1306 text.Printf(wxT("%ld"), value);
1307 }
1308 else // using unconstrained input
1309 #endif // wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1310 {
1311 const wxString textOld(grid->GetCellValue(row, col));
1312 text = Text()->GetValue();
1313 if ( text.empty() )
1314 {
1315 if ( textOld.empty() )
1316 return false;
1317 }
1318 else // non-empty text now (maybe 0)
1319 {
1320 if ( !text.ToLong(&value) )
1321 return false;
1322
1323 // if value == m_valueOld == 0 but old text was "" and new one is
1324 // "0" something still did change
1325 if ( value == m_valueOld && (value || !textOld.empty()) )
1326 return false;
1327 }
1328 }
1329
1330 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1331 if ( table->CanSetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
1332 table->SetValueAsLong(row, col, value);
1333 else
1334 table->SetValue(row, col, text);
1335
1336 return true;
1337 }
1338
1339 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::Reset()
1340 {
1341 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1342 if ( HasRange() )
1343 {
1344 Spin()->SetValue((int)m_valueOld);
1345 }
1346 else
1347 #endif
1348 {
1349 DoReset(GetString());
1350 }
1351 }
1352
1353 bool wxGridCellNumberEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1354 {
1355 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1356 {
1357 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1358 if ( (keycode < 128) &&
1359 (wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-'))
1360 {
1361 return true;
1362 }
1363 }
1364
1365 return false;
1366 }
1367
1368 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1369 {
1370 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1371 if ( !HasRange() )
1372 {
1373 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-')
1374 {
1375 wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(event);
1376
1377 // skip Skip() below
1378 return;
1379 }
1380 }
1381 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1382 else
1383 {
1384 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) )
1385 {
1386 wxSpinCtrl* spin = (wxSpinCtrl*)m_control;
1387 spin->SetValue(keycode - '0');
1388 spin->SetSelection(1,1);
1389 return;
1390 }
1391 }
1392 #endif
1393
1394 event.Skip();
1395 }
1396
1397 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1398 {
1399 if ( !params )
1400 {
1401 // reset to default
1402 m_min =
1403 m_max = -1;
1404 }
1405 else
1406 {
1407 long tmp;
1408 if ( params.BeforeFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1409 {
1410 m_min = (int)tmp;
1411
1412 if ( params.AfterFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1413 {
1414 m_max = (int)tmp;
1415
1416 // skip the error message below
1417 return;
1418 }
1419 }
1420
1421 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellNumberEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str());
1422 }
1423 }
1424
1425 // return the value in the spin control if it is there (the text control otherwise)
1426 wxString wxGridCellNumberEditor::GetValue() const
1427 {
1428 wxString s;
1429
1430 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1431 if ( HasRange() )
1432 {
1433 long value = Spin()->GetValue();
1434 s.Printf(wxT("%ld"), value);
1435 }
1436 else
1437 #endif
1438 {
1439 s = Text()->GetValue();
1440 }
1441
1442 return s;
1443 }
1444
1445 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1446 // wxGridCellFloatEditor
1447 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1448
1449 wxGridCellFloatEditor::wxGridCellFloatEditor(int width, int precision)
1450 {
1451 m_width = width;
1452 m_precision = precision;
1453 }
1454
1455 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1456 wxWindowID id,
1457 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1458 {
1459 wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1460
1461 #if wxUSE_VALIDATORS
1462 Text()->SetValidator(wxTextValidator(wxFILTER_NUMERIC));
1463 #endif
1464 }
1465
1466 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1467 {
1468 // first get the value
1469 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1470 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
1471 {
1472 m_valueOld = table->GetValueAsDouble(row, col);
1473 }
1474 else
1475 {
1476 m_valueOld = 0.0;
1477
1478 const wxString value = table->GetValue(row, col);
1479 if ( !value.empty() )
1480 {
1481 if ( !value.ToDouble(&m_valueOld) )
1482 {
1483 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("this cell doesn't have float value") );
1484 return;
1485 }
1486 }
1487 }
1488
1489 DoBeginEdit(GetString());
1490 }
1491
1492 bool wxGridCellFloatEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1493 {
1494 const wxString text(Text()->GetValue()),
1495 textOld(grid->GetCellValue(row, col));
1496
1497 double value;
1498 if ( !text.empty() )
1499 {
1500 if ( !text.ToDouble(&value) )
1501 return false;
1502 }
1503 else // new value is empty string
1504 {
1505 if ( textOld.empty() )
1506 return false; // nothing changed
1507
1508 value = 0.;
1509 }
1510
1511 // the test for empty strings ensures that we don't skip the value setting
1512 // when "" is replaced by "0" or vice versa as "" numeric value is also 0.
1513 if ( wxIsSameDouble(value, m_valueOld) && !text.empty() && !textOld.empty() )
1514 return false; // nothing changed
1515
1516 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1517
1518 if ( table->CanSetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
1519 table->SetValueAsDouble(row, col, value);
1520 else
1521 table->SetValue(row, col, text);
1522
1523 return true;
1524 }
1525
1526 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::Reset()
1527 {
1528 DoReset(GetString());
1529 }
1530
1531 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1532 {
1533 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1534 char tmpbuf[2];
1535 tmpbuf[0] = (char) keycode;
1536 tmpbuf[1] = '\0';
1537 wxString strbuf(tmpbuf, *wxConvCurrent);
1538
1539 #if wxUSE_INTL
1540 bool is_decimal_point = ( strbuf ==
1541 wxLocale::GetInfo(wxLOCALE_DECIMAL_POINT, wxLOCALE_CAT_NUMBER) );
1542 #else
1543 bool is_decimal_point = ( strbuf == _T(".") );
1544 #endif
1545
1546 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-'
1547 || is_decimal_point )
1548 {
1549 wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(event);
1550
1551 // skip Skip() below
1552 return;
1553 }
1554
1555 event.Skip();
1556 }
1557
1558 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1559 {
1560 if ( !params )
1561 {
1562 // reset to default
1563 m_width =
1564 m_precision = -1;
1565 }
1566 else
1567 {
1568 long tmp;
1569 if ( params.BeforeFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1570 {
1571 m_width = (int)tmp;
1572
1573 if ( params.AfterFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1574 {
1575 m_precision = (int)tmp;
1576
1577 // skip the error message below
1578 return;
1579 }
1580 }
1581
1582 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str());
1583 }
1584 }
1585
1586 wxString wxGridCellFloatEditor::GetString() const
1587 {
1588 wxString fmt;
1589 if ( m_precision == -1 && m_width != -1)
1590 {
1591 // default precision
1592 fmt.Printf(_T("%%%d.f"), m_width);
1593 }
1594 else if ( m_precision != -1 && m_width == -1)
1595 {
1596 // default width
1597 fmt.Printf(_T("%%.%df"), m_precision);
1598 }
1599 else if ( m_precision != -1 && m_width != -1 )
1600 {
1601 fmt.Printf(_T("%%%d.%df"), m_width, m_precision);
1602 }
1603 else
1604 {
1605 // default width/precision
1606 fmt = _T("%f");
1607 }
1608
1609 return wxString::Format(fmt, m_valueOld);
1610 }
1611
1612 bool wxGridCellFloatEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1613 {
1614 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1615 {
1616 const int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1617 if ( isascii(keycode) )
1618 {
1619 char tmpbuf[2];
1620 tmpbuf[0] = (char) keycode;
1621 tmpbuf[1] = '\0';
1622 wxString strbuf(tmpbuf, *wxConvCurrent);
1623
1624 #if wxUSE_INTL
1625 const wxString decimalPoint =
1626 wxLocale::GetInfo(wxLOCALE_DECIMAL_POINT, wxLOCALE_CAT_NUMBER);
1627 #else
1628 const wxString decimalPoint(_T('.'));
1629 #endif
1630
1631 // accept digits, 'e' as in '1e+6', also '-', '+', and '.'
1632 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) ||
1633 tolower(keycode) == 'e' ||
1634 keycode == decimalPoint ||
1635 keycode == '+' ||
1636 keycode == '-' )
1637 {
1638 return true;
1639 }
1640 }
1641 }
1642
1643 return false;
1644 }
1645
1646 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
1647
1648 #if wxUSE_CHECKBOX
1649
1650 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1651 // wxGridCellBoolEditor
1652 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1653
1654 // the default values for GetValue()
1655 wxString wxGridCellBoolEditor::ms_stringValues[2] = { _T(""), _T("1") };
1656
1657 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1658 wxWindowID id,
1659 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1660 {
1661 m_control = new wxCheckBox(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
1662 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1663 wxNO_BORDER);
1664
1665 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1666 }
1667
1668 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& r)
1669 {
1670 bool resize = false;
1671 wxSize size = m_control->GetSize();
1672 wxCoord minSize = wxMin(r.width, r.height);
1673
1674 // check if the checkbox is not too big/small for this cell
1675 wxSize sizeBest = m_control->GetBestSize();
1676 if ( !(size == sizeBest) )
1677 {
1678 // reset to default size if it had been made smaller
1679 size = sizeBest;
1680
1681 resize = true;
1682 }
1683
1684 if ( size.x >= minSize || size.y >= minSize )
1685 {
1686 // leave 1 pixel margin
1687 size.x = size.y = minSize - 2;
1688
1689 resize = true;
1690 }
1691
1692 if ( resize )
1693 {
1694 m_control->SetSize(size);
1695 }
1696
1697 // position it in the centre of the rectangle (TODO: support alignment?)
1698
1699 #if defined(__WXGTK__) || defined (__WXMOTIF__)
1700 // the checkbox without label still has some space to the right in wxGTK,
1701 // so shift it to the right
1702 size.x -= 8;
1703 #elif defined(__WXMSW__)
1704 // here too, but in other way
1705 size.x += 1;
1706 size.y -= 2;
1707 #endif
1708
1709 int hAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
1710 int vAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
1711 if (GetCellAttr())
1712 GetCellAttr()->GetAlignment(& hAlign, & vAlign);
1713
1714 int x = 0, y = 0;
1715 if (hAlign == wxALIGN_LEFT)
1716 {
1717 x = r.x + 2;
1718
1719 #ifdef __WXMSW__
1720 x += 2;
1721 #endif
1722
1723 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1724 }
1725 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_RIGHT)
1726 {
1727 x = r.x + r.width - size.x - 2;
1728 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1729 }
1730 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_CENTRE)
1731 {
1732 x = r.x + r.width / 2 - size.x / 2;
1733 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1734 }
1735
1736 m_control->Move(x, y);
1737 }
1738
1739 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Show(bool show, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
1740 {
1741 m_control->Show(show);
1742
1743 if ( show )
1744 {
1745 wxColour colBg = attr ? attr->GetBackgroundColour() : *wxLIGHT_GREY;
1746 CBox()->SetBackgroundColour(colBg);
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1751 {
1752 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1753 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1754
1755 if (grid->GetTable()->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL))
1756 {
1757 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValueAsBool(row, col);
1758 }
1759 else
1760 {
1761 wxString cellval( grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col) );
1762
1763 if ( cellval == ms_stringValues[false] )
1764 m_startValue = false;
1765 else if ( cellval == ms_stringValues[true] )
1766 m_startValue = true;
1767 else
1768 {
1769 // do not try to be smart here and convert it to true or false
1770 // because we'll still overwrite it with something different and
1771 // this risks to be very surprising for the user code, let them
1772 // know about it
1773 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("invalid value for a cell with bool editor!") );
1774 }
1775 }
1776
1777 CBox()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1778 CBox()->SetFocus();
1779 }
1780
1781 bool wxGridCellBoolEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
1782 wxGrid* grid)
1783 {
1784 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1785 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1786
1787 bool changed = false;
1788 bool value = CBox()->GetValue();
1789 if ( value != m_startValue )
1790 changed = true;
1791
1792 if ( changed )
1793 {
1794 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1795 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL) )
1796 table->SetValueAsBool(row, col, value);
1797 else
1798 table->SetValue(row, col, GetValue());
1799 }
1800
1801 return changed;
1802 }
1803
1804 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Reset()
1805 {
1806 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1807 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1808
1809 CBox()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1810 }
1811
1812 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::StartingClick()
1813 {
1814 CBox()->SetValue(!CBox()->GetValue());
1815 }
1816
1817 bool wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1818 {
1819 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1820 {
1821 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1822 switch ( keycode )
1823 {
1824 case WXK_SPACE:
1825 case '+':
1826 case '-':
1827 return true;
1828 }
1829 }
1830
1831 return false;
1832 }
1833
1834 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1835 {
1836 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1837 switch ( keycode )
1838 {
1839 case WXK_SPACE:
1840 CBox()->SetValue(!CBox()->GetValue());
1841 break;
1842
1843 case '+':
1844 CBox()->SetValue(true);
1845 break;
1846
1847 case '-':
1848 CBox()->SetValue(false);
1849 break;
1850 }
1851 }
1852
1853 wxString wxGridCellBoolEditor::GetValue() const
1854 {
1855 return ms_stringValues[CBox()->GetValue()];
1856 }
1857
1858 /* static */ void
1859 wxGridCellBoolEditor::UseStringValues(const wxString& valueTrue,
1860 const wxString& valueFalse)
1861 {
1862 ms_stringValues[false] = valueFalse;
1863 ms_stringValues[true] = valueTrue;
1864 }
1865
1866 /* static */ bool
1867 wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsTrueValue(const wxString& value)
1868 {
1869 return value == ms_stringValues[true];
1870 }
1871
1872 #endif // wxUSE_CHECKBOX
1873
1874 #if wxUSE_COMBOBOX
1875
1876 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1877 // wxGridCellChoiceEditor
1878 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1879
1880 wxGridCellChoiceEditor::wxGridCellChoiceEditor(const wxArrayString& choices,
1881 bool allowOthers)
1882 : m_choices(choices),
1883 m_allowOthers(allowOthers) { }
1884
1885 wxGridCellChoiceEditor::wxGridCellChoiceEditor(size_t count,
1886 const wxString choices[],
1887 bool allowOthers)
1888 : m_allowOthers(allowOthers)
1889 {
1890 if ( count )
1891 {
1892 m_choices.Alloc(count);
1893 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
1894 {
1895 m_choices.Add(choices[n]);
1896 }
1897 }
1898 }
1899
1900 wxGridCellEditor *wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Clone() const
1901 {
1902 wxGridCellChoiceEditor *editor = new wxGridCellChoiceEditor;
1903 editor->m_allowOthers = m_allowOthers;
1904 editor->m_choices = m_choices;
1905
1906 return editor;
1907 }
1908
1909 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1910 wxWindowID id,
1911 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1912 {
1913 int style = wxTE_PROCESS_ENTER |
1914 wxTE_PROCESS_TAB |
1915 wxBORDER_NONE;
1916
1917 if ( !m_allowOthers )
1918 style |= wxCB_READONLY;
1919 m_control = new wxComboBox(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
1920 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1921 m_choices,
1922 style);
1923
1924 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1925 }
1926
1927 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& rectCell,
1928 wxGridCellAttr * attr)
1929 {
1930 // as we fill the entire client area, don't do anything here to minimize
1931 // flicker
1932
1933 // TODO: It doesn't actually fill the client area since the height of a
1934 // combo always defaults to the standard. Until someone has time to
1935 // figure out the right rectangle to paint, just do it the normal way.
1936 wxGridCellEditor::PaintBackground(rectCell, attr);
1937 }
1938
1939 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1940 {
1941 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1942 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1943
1944 wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler* evtHandler = NULL;
1945 if (m_control)
1946 evtHandler = wxDynamicCast(m_control->GetEventHandler(), wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler);
1947
1948 // Don't immediately end if we get a kill focus event within BeginEdit
1949 if (evtHandler)
1950 evtHandler->SetInSetFocus(true);
1951
1952 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col);
1953
1954 Reset(); // this updates combo box to correspond to m_startValue
1955
1956 Combo()->SetFocus();
1957
1958 if (evtHandler)
1959 {
1960 // When dropping down the menu, a kill focus event
1961 // happens after this point, so we can't reset the flag yet.
1962 #if !defined(__WXGTK20__)
1963 evtHandler->SetInSetFocus(false);
1964 #endif
1965 }
1966 }
1967
1968 bool wxGridCellChoiceEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
1969 wxGrid* grid)
1970 {
1971 wxString value = Combo()->GetValue();
1972 if ( value == m_startValue )
1973 return false;
1974
1975 grid->GetTable()->SetValue(row, col, value);
1976
1977 return true;
1978 }
1979
1980 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Reset()
1981 {
1982 if (m_allowOthers)
1983 {
1984 Combo()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1985 Combo()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
1986 }
1987 else // the combobox is read-only
1988 {
1989 // find the right position, or default to the first if not found
1990 int pos = Combo()->FindString(m_startValue);
1991 if (pos == wxNOT_FOUND)
1992 pos = 0;
1993 Combo()->SetSelection(pos);
1994 }
1995 }
1996
1997 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1998 {
1999 if ( !params )
2000 {
2001 // what can we do?
2002 return;
2003 }
2004
2005 m_choices.Empty();
2006
2007 wxStringTokenizer tk(params, _T(','));
2008 while ( tk.HasMoreTokens() )
2009 {
2010 m_choices.Add(tk.GetNextToken());
2011 }
2012 }
2013
2014 // return the value in the text control
2015 wxString wxGridCellChoiceEditor::GetValue() const
2016 {
2017 return Combo()->GetValue();
2018 }
2019
2020 #endif // wxUSE_COMBOBOX
2021
2022 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2023 // wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler
2024 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2025
2026 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKillFocus(wxFocusEvent& event)
2027 {
2028 // Don't disable the cell if we're just starting to edit it
2029 if (m_inSetFocus)
2030 return;
2031
2032 // accept changes
2033 m_grid->DisableCellEditControl();
2034
2035 event.Skip();
2036 }
2037
2038 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKeyDown(wxKeyEvent& event)
2039 {
2040 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
2041 {
2042 case WXK_ESCAPE:
2043 m_editor->Reset();
2044 m_grid->DisableCellEditControl();
2045 break;
2046
2047 case WXK_TAB:
2048 m_grid->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event );
2049 break;
2050
2051 case WXK_RETURN:
2052 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
2053 if (!m_grid->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event))
2054 m_editor->HandleReturn(event);
2055 break;
2056
2057 default:
2058 event.Skip();
2059 break;
2060 }
2061 }
2062
2063 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnChar(wxKeyEvent& event)
2064 {
2065 int row = m_grid->GetGridCursorRow();
2066 int col = m_grid->GetGridCursorCol();
2067 wxRect rect = m_grid->CellToRect( row, col );
2068 int cw, ch;
2069 m_grid->GetGridWindow()->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
2070
2071 // if cell width is smaller than grid client area, cell is wholly visible
2072 bool wholeCellVisible = (rect.GetWidth() < cw);
2073
2074 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
2075 {
2076 case WXK_ESCAPE:
2077 case WXK_TAB:
2078 case WXK_RETURN:
2079 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
2080 break;
2081
2082 case WXK_HOME:
2083 {
2084 if ( wholeCellVisible )
2085 {
2086 // no special processing needed...
2087 event.Skip();
2088 break;
2089 }
2090
2091 // do special processing for partly visible cell...
2092
2093 // get the widths of all cells previous to this one
2094 int colXPos = 0;
2095 for ( int i = 0; i < col; i++ )
2096 {
2097 colXPos += m_grid->GetColSize(i);
2098 }
2099
2100 int xUnit = 1, yUnit = 1;
2101 m_grid->GetScrollPixelsPerUnit(&xUnit, &yUnit);
2102 if (col != 0)
2103 {
2104 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit - 1, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
2105 }
2106 else
2107 {
2108 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
2109 }
2110 event.Skip();
2111 break;
2112 }
2113
2114 case WXK_END:
2115 {
2116 if ( wholeCellVisible )
2117 {
2118 // no special processing needed...
2119 event.Skip();
2120 break;
2121 }
2122
2123 // do special processing for partly visible cell...
2124
2125 int textWidth = 0;
2126 wxString value = m_grid->GetCellValue(row, col);
2127 if ( wxEmptyString != value )
2128 {
2129 // get width of cell CONTENTS (text)
2130 int y;
2131 wxFont font = m_grid->GetCellFont(row, col);
2132 m_grid->GetTextExtent(value, &textWidth, &y, NULL, NULL, &font);
2133
2134 // try to RIGHT align the text by scrolling
2135 int client_right = m_grid->GetGridWindow()->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
2136
2137 // (m_grid->GetScrollLineX()*2) is a factor for not scrolling to far,
2138 // otherwise the last part of the cell content might be hidden below the scroll bar
2139 // FIXME: maybe there is a more suitable correction?
2140 textWidth -= (client_right - (m_grid->GetScrollLineX() * 2));
2141 if ( textWidth < 0 )
2142 {
2143 textWidth = 0;
2144 }
2145 }
2146
2147 // get the widths of all cells previous to this one
2148 int colXPos = 0;
2149 for ( int i = 0; i < col; i++ )
2150 {
2151 colXPos += m_grid->GetColSize(i);
2152 }
2153
2154 // and add the (modified) text width of the cell contents
2155 // as we'd like to see the last part of the cell contents
2156 colXPos += textWidth;
2157
2158 int xUnit = 1, yUnit = 1;
2159 m_grid->GetScrollPixelsPerUnit(&xUnit, &yUnit);
2160 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit - 1, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
2161 event.Skip();
2162 break;
2163 }
2164
2165 default:
2166 event.Skip();
2167 break;
2168 }
2169 }
2170
2171 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2172 // wxGridCellWorker is an (almost) empty common base class for
2173 // wxGridCellRenderer and wxGridCellEditor managing ref counting
2174 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2175
2176 void wxGridCellWorker::SetParameters(const wxString& WXUNUSED(params))
2177 {
2178 // nothing to do
2179 }
2180
2181 wxGridCellWorker::~wxGridCellWorker()
2182 {
2183 }
2184
2185 // ============================================================================
2186 // renderer classes
2187 // ============================================================================
2188
2189 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2190 // wxGridCellRenderer
2191 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2192
2193 void wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2194 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2195 wxDC& dc,
2196 const wxRect& rect,
2197 int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
2198 bool isSelected)
2199 {
2200 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID );
2201
2202 wxColour clr;
2203 if ( grid.IsEnabled() )
2204 {
2205 if ( isSelected )
2206 {
2207 if ( grid.HasFocus() )
2208 clr = grid.GetSelectionBackground();
2209 else
2210 clr = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNSHADOW);
2211 }
2212 else
2213 {
2214 clr = attr.GetBackgroundColour();
2215 }
2216 }
2217 else // grey out fields if the grid is disabled
2218 {
2219 clr = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE);
2220 }
2221
2222 dc.SetBrush(clr);
2223 dc.SetPen( *wxTRANSPARENT_PEN );
2224 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
2225 }
2226
2227 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2228 // wxGridCellStringRenderer
2229 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2230
2231 void wxGridCellStringRenderer::SetTextColoursAndFont(const wxGrid& grid,
2232 const wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2233 wxDC& dc,
2234 bool isSelected)
2235 {
2236 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
2237
2238 // TODO some special colours for attr.IsReadOnly() case?
2239
2240 // different coloured text when the grid is disabled
2241 if ( grid.IsEnabled() )
2242 {
2243 if ( isSelected )
2244 {
2245 wxColour clr;
2246 if ( grid.HasFocus() )
2247 clr = grid.GetSelectionBackground();
2248 else
2249 clr = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNSHADOW);
2250 dc.SetTextBackground( clr );
2251 dc.SetTextForeground( grid.GetSelectionForeground() );
2252 }
2253 else
2254 {
2255 dc.SetTextBackground( attr.GetBackgroundColour() );
2256 dc.SetTextForeground( attr.GetTextColour() );
2257 }
2258 }
2259 else
2260 {
2261 dc.SetTextBackground(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE));
2262 dc.SetTextForeground(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_GRAYTEXT));
2263 }
2264
2265 dc.SetFont( attr.GetFont() );
2266 }
2267
2268 wxSize wxGridCellStringRenderer::DoGetBestSize(const wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2269 wxDC& dc,
2270 const wxString& text)
2271 {
2272 wxCoord x = 0, y = 0, max_x = 0;
2273 dc.SetFont(attr.GetFont());
2274 wxStringTokenizer tk(text, _T('\n'));
2275 while ( tk.HasMoreTokens() )
2276 {
2277 dc.GetTextExtent(tk.GetNextToken(), &x, &y);
2278 max_x = wxMax(max_x, x);
2279 }
2280
2281 y *= 1 + text.Freq(wxT('\n')); // multiply by the number of lines.
2282
2283 return wxSize(max_x, y);
2284 }
2285
2286 wxSize wxGridCellStringRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2287 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2288 wxDC& dc,
2289 int row, int col)
2290 {
2291 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col));
2292 }
2293
2294 void wxGridCellStringRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2295 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2296 wxDC& dc,
2297 const wxRect& rectCell,
2298 int row, int col,
2299 bool isSelected)
2300 {
2301 wxRect rect = rectCell;
2302 rect.Inflate(-1);
2303
2304 // erase only this cells background, overflow cells should have been erased
2305 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
2306
2307 int hAlign, vAlign;
2308 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2309
2310 int overflowCols = 0;
2311
2312 if (attr.GetOverflow())
2313 {
2314 int cols = grid.GetNumberCols();
2315 int best_width = GetBestSize(grid,attr,dc,row,col).GetWidth();
2316 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
2317 attr.GetSize( &cell_rows, &cell_cols ); // shouldn't get here if <= 0
2318 if ((best_width > rectCell.width) && (col < cols) && grid.GetTable())
2319 {
2320 int i, c_cols, c_rows;
2321 for (i = col+cell_cols; i < cols; i++)
2322 {
2323 bool is_empty = true;
2324 for (int j=row; j < row + cell_rows; j++)
2325 {
2326 // check w/ anchor cell for multicell block
2327 grid.GetCellSize(j, i, &c_rows, &c_cols);
2328 if (c_rows > 0)
2329 c_rows = 0;
2330 if (!grid.GetTable()->IsEmptyCell(j + c_rows, i))
2331 {
2332 is_empty = false;
2333 break;
2334 }
2335 }
2336
2337 if (is_empty)
2338 {
2339 rect.width += grid.GetColSize(i);
2340 }
2341 else
2342 {
2343 i--;
2344 break;
2345 }
2346
2347 if (rect.width >= best_width)
2348 break;
2349 }
2350
2351 overflowCols = i - col - cell_cols + 1;
2352 if (overflowCols >= cols)
2353 overflowCols = cols - 1;
2354 }
2355
2356 if (overflowCols > 0) // redraw overflow cells w/ proper hilight
2357 {
2358 hAlign = wxALIGN_LEFT; // if oveflowed then it's left aligned
2359 wxRect clip = rect;
2360 clip.x += rectCell.width;
2361 // draw each overflow cell individually
2362 int col_end = col + cell_cols + overflowCols;
2363 if (col_end >= grid.GetNumberCols())
2364 col_end = grid.GetNumberCols() - 1;
2365 for (int i = col + cell_cols; i <= col_end; i++)
2366 {
2367 clip.width = grid.GetColSize(i) - 1;
2368 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
2369 dc.SetClippingRegion(clip);
2370
2371 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc,
2372 grid.IsInSelection(row,i));
2373
2374 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col),
2375 rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2376 clip.x += grid.GetColSize(i) - 1;
2377 }
2378
2379 rect = rectCell;
2380 rect.Inflate(-1);
2381 rect.width++;
2382 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
2383 }
2384 }
2385
2386 // now we only have to draw the text
2387 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2388
2389 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col),
2390 rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2391 }
2392
2393 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2394 // wxGridCellNumberRenderer
2395 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2396
2397 wxString wxGridCellNumberRenderer::GetString(const wxGrid& grid, int row, int col)
2398 {
2399 wxGridTableBase *table = grid.GetTable();
2400 wxString text;
2401 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
2402 {
2403 text.Printf(_T("%ld"), table->GetValueAsLong(row, col));
2404 }
2405 else
2406 {
2407 text = table->GetValue(row, col);
2408 }
2409
2410 return text;
2411 }
2412
2413 void wxGridCellNumberRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2414 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2415 wxDC& dc,
2416 const wxRect& rectCell,
2417 int row, int col,
2418 bool isSelected)
2419 {
2420 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
2421
2422 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2423
2424 // draw the text right aligned by default
2425 int hAlign, vAlign;
2426 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2427 hAlign = wxALIGN_RIGHT;
2428
2429 wxRect rect = rectCell;
2430 rect.Inflate(-1);
2431
2432 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, GetString(grid, row, col), rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2433 }
2434
2435 wxSize wxGridCellNumberRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2436 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2437 wxDC& dc,
2438 int row, int col)
2439 {
2440 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, GetString(grid, row, col));
2441 }
2442
2443 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2444 // wxGridCellFloatRenderer
2445 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2446
2447 wxGridCellFloatRenderer::wxGridCellFloatRenderer(int width, int precision)
2448 {
2449 SetWidth(width);
2450 SetPrecision(precision);
2451 }
2452
2453 wxGridCellRenderer *wxGridCellFloatRenderer::Clone() const
2454 {
2455 wxGridCellFloatRenderer *renderer = new wxGridCellFloatRenderer;
2456 renderer->m_width = m_width;
2457 renderer->m_precision = m_precision;
2458 renderer->m_format = m_format;
2459
2460 return renderer;
2461 }
2462
2463 wxString wxGridCellFloatRenderer::GetString(const wxGrid& grid, int row, int col)
2464 {
2465 wxGridTableBase *table = grid.GetTable();
2466
2467 bool hasDouble;
2468 double val;
2469 wxString text;
2470 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
2471 {
2472 val = table->GetValueAsDouble(row, col);
2473 hasDouble = true;
2474 }
2475 else
2476 {
2477 text = table->GetValue(row, col);
2478 hasDouble = text.ToDouble(&val);
2479 }
2480
2481 if ( hasDouble )
2482 {
2483 if ( !m_format )
2484 {
2485 if ( m_width == -1 )
2486 {
2487 if ( m_precision == -1 )
2488 {
2489 // default width/precision
2490 m_format = _T("%f");
2491 }
2492 else
2493 {
2494 m_format.Printf(_T("%%.%df"), m_precision);
2495 }
2496 }
2497 else if ( m_precision == -1 )
2498 {
2499 // default precision
2500 m_format.Printf(_T("%%%d.f"), m_width);
2501 }
2502 else
2503 {
2504 m_format.Printf(_T("%%%d.%df"), m_width, m_precision);
2505 }
2506 }
2507
2508 text.Printf(m_format, val);
2509
2510 }
2511 //else: text already contains the string
2512
2513 return text;
2514 }
2515
2516 void wxGridCellFloatRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2517 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2518 wxDC& dc,
2519 const wxRect& rectCell,
2520 int row, int col,
2521 bool isSelected)
2522 {
2523 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
2524
2525 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2526
2527 // draw the text right aligned by default
2528 int hAlign, vAlign;
2529 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2530 hAlign = wxALIGN_RIGHT;
2531
2532 wxRect rect = rectCell;
2533 rect.Inflate(-1);
2534
2535 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, GetString(grid, row, col), rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2536 }
2537
2538 wxSize wxGridCellFloatRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2539 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2540 wxDC& dc,
2541 int row, int col)
2542 {
2543 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, GetString(grid, row, col));
2544 }
2545
2546 void wxGridCellFloatRenderer::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
2547 {
2548 if ( !params )
2549 {
2550 // reset to defaults
2551 SetWidth(-1);
2552 SetPrecision(-1);
2553 }
2554 else
2555 {
2556 wxString tmp = params.BeforeFirst(_T(','));
2557 if ( !tmp.empty() )
2558 {
2559 long width;
2560 if ( tmp.ToLong(&width) )
2561 {
2562 SetWidth((int)width);
2563 }
2564 else
2565 {
2566 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatRenderer width parameter string '%s ignored"), params.c_str());
2567 }
2568 }
2569
2570 tmp = params.AfterFirst(_T(','));
2571 if ( !tmp.empty() )
2572 {
2573 long precision;
2574 if ( tmp.ToLong(&precision) )
2575 {
2576 SetPrecision((int)precision);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 {
2580 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatRenderer precision parameter string '%s ignored"), params.c_str());
2581 }
2582 }
2583 }
2584 }
2585
2586 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2587 // wxGridCellBoolRenderer
2588 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2589
2590 wxSize wxGridCellBoolRenderer::ms_sizeCheckMark;
2591
2592 // FIXME these checkbox size calculations are really ugly...
2593
2594 // between checkmark and box
2595 static const wxCoord wxGRID_CHECKMARK_MARGIN = 2;
2596
2597 wxSize wxGridCellBoolRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2598 wxGridCellAttr& WXUNUSED(attr),
2599 wxDC& WXUNUSED(dc),
2600 int WXUNUSED(row),
2601 int WXUNUSED(col))
2602 {
2603 // compute it only once (no locks for MT safeness in GUI thread...)
2604 if ( !ms_sizeCheckMark.x )
2605 {
2606 // get checkbox size
2607 wxCheckBox *checkbox = new wxCheckBox(&grid, wxID_ANY, wxEmptyString);
2608 wxSize size = checkbox->GetBestSize();
2609 wxCoord checkSize = size.y + 2 * wxGRID_CHECKMARK_MARGIN;
2610
2611 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
2612 checkSize -= size.y / 2;
2613 #endif
2614
2615 delete checkbox;
2616
2617 ms_sizeCheckMark.x = ms_sizeCheckMark.y = checkSize;
2618 }
2619
2620 return ms_sizeCheckMark;
2621 }
2622
2623 void wxGridCellBoolRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2624 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2625 wxDC& dc,
2626 const wxRect& rect,
2627 int row, int col,
2628 bool isSelected)
2629 {
2630 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rect, row, col, isSelected);
2631
2632 // draw a check mark in the centre (ignoring alignment - TODO)
2633 wxSize size = GetBestSize(grid, attr, dc, row, col);
2634
2635 // don't draw outside the cell
2636 wxCoord minSize = wxMin(rect.width, rect.height);
2637 if ( size.x >= minSize || size.y >= minSize )
2638 {
2639 // and even leave (at least) 1 pixel margin
2640 size.x = size.y = minSize;
2641 }
2642
2643 // draw a border around checkmark
2644 int vAlign, hAlign;
2645 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2646
2647 wxRect rectBorder;
2648 if (hAlign == wxALIGN_CENTRE)
2649 {
2650 rectBorder.x = rect.x + rect.width / 2 - size.x / 2;
2651 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2652 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2653 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2654 }
2655 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_LEFT)
2656 {
2657 rectBorder.x = rect.x + 2;
2658 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2659 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2660 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2661 }
2662 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_RIGHT)
2663 {
2664 rectBorder.x = rect.x + rect.width - size.x - 2;
2665 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2666 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2667 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2668 }
2669
2670 bool value;
2671 if ( grid.GetTable()->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL) )
2672 {
2673 value = grid.GetTable()->GetValueAsBool(row, col);
2674 }
2675 else
2676 {
2677 wxString cellval( grid.GetTable()->GetValue(row, col) );
2678 value = wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsTrueValue(cellval);
2679 }
2680
2681 int flags = 0;
2682 if (value)
2683 flags |= wxCONTROL_CHECKED;
2684
2685 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawCheckBox( &grid, dc, rectBorder, flags );
2686 }
2687
2688 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2689 // wxGridCellAttr
2690 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2691
2692 void wxGridCellAttr::Init(wxGridCellAttr *attrDefault)
2693 {
2694 m_nRef = 1;
2695
2696 m_isReadOnly = Unset;
2697
2698 m_renderer = NULL;
2699 m_editor = NULL;
2700
2701 m_attrkind = wxGridCellAttr::Cell;
2702
2703 m_sizeRows = m_sizeCols = 1;
2704 m_overflow = UnsetOverflow;
2705
2706 SetDefAttr(attrDefault);
2707 }
2708
2709 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttr::Clone() const
2710 {
2711 wxGridCellAttr *attr = new wxGridCellAttr(m_defGridAttr);
2712
2713 if ( HasTextColour() )
2714 attr->SetTextColour(GetTextColour());
2715 if ( HasBackgroundColour() )
2716 attr->SetBackgroundColour(GetBackgroundColour());
2717 if ( HasFont() )
2718 attr->SetFont(GetFont());
2719 if ( HasAlignment() )
2720 attr->SetAlignment(m_hAlign, m_vAlign);
2721
2722 attr->SetSize( m_sizeRows, m_sizeCols );
2723
2724 if ( m_renderer )
2725 {
2726 attr->SetRenderer(m_renderer);
2727 m_renderer->IncRef();
2728 }
2729 if ( m_editor )
2730 {
2731 attr->SetEditor(m_editor);
2732 m_editor->IncRef();
2733 }
2734
2735 if ( IsReadOnly() )
2736 attr->SetReadOnly();
2737
2738 attr->SetOverflow( m_overflow == Overflow );
2739 attr->SetKind( m_attrkind );
2740
2741 return attr;
2742 }
2743
2744 void wxGridCellAttr::MergeWith(wxGridCellAttr *mergefrom)
2745 {
2746 if ( !HasTextColour() && mergefrom->HasTextColour() )
2747 SetTextColour(mergefrom->GetTextColour());
2748 if ( !HasBackgroundColour() && mergefrom->HasBackgroundColour() )
2749 SetBackgroundColour(mergefrom->GetBackgroundColour());
2750 if ( !HasFont() && mergefrom->HasFont() )
2751 SetFont(mergefrom->GetFont());
2752 if ( !HasAlignment() && mergefrom->HasAlignment() )
2753 {
2754 int hAlign, vAlign;
2755 mergefrom->GetAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign);
2756 SetAlignment(hAlign, vAlign);
2757 }
2758 if ( !HasSize() && mergefrom->HasSize() )
2759 mergefrom->GetSize( &m_sizeRows, &m_sizeCols );
2760
2761 // Directly access member functions as GetRender/Editor don't just return
2762 // m_renderer/m_editor
2763 //
2764 // Maybe add support for merge of Render and Editor?
2765 if (!HasRenderer() && mergefrom->HasRenderer() )
2766 {
2767 m_renderer = mergefrom->m_renderer;
2768 m_renderer->IncRef();
2769 }
2770 if ( !HasEditor() && mergefrom->HasEditor() )
2771 {
2772 m_editor = mergefrom->m_editor;
2773 m_editor->IncRef();
2774 }
2775 if ( !HasReadWriteMode() && mergefrom->HasReadWriteMode() )
2776 SetReadOnly(mergefrom->IsReadOnly());
2777
2778 if (!HasOverflowMode() && mergefrom->HasOverflowMode() )
2779 SetOverflow(mergefrom->GetOverflow());
2780
2781 SetDefAttr(mergefrom->m_defGridAttr);
2782 }
2783
2784 void wxGridCellAttr::SetSize(int num_rows, int num_cols)
2785 {
2786 // The size of a cell is normally 1,1
2787
2788 // If this cell is larger (2,2) then this is the top left cell
2789 // the other cells that will be covered (lower right cells) must be
2790 // set to negative or zero values such that
2791 // row + num_rows of the covered cell points to the larger cell (this cell)
2792 // same goes for the col + num_cols.
2793
2794 // Size of 0,0 is NOT valid, neither is <=0 and any positive value
2795
2796 wxASSERT_MSG( (!((num_rows > 0) && (num_cols <= 0)) ||
2797 !((num_rows <= 0) && (num_cols > 0)) ||
2798 !((num_rows == 0) && (num_cols == 0))),
2799 wxT("wxGridCellAttr::SetSize only takes two postive values or negative/zero values"));
2800
2801 m_sizeRows = num_rows;
2802 m_sizeCols = num_cols;
2803 }
2804
2805 const wxColour& wxGridCellAttr::GetTextColour() const
2806 {
2807 if (HasTextColour())
2808 {
2809 return m_colText;
2810 }
2811 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2812 {
2813 return m_defGridAttr->GetTextColour();
2814 }
2815 else
2816 {
2817 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2818 return wxNullColour;
2819 }
2820 }
2821
2822 const wxColour& wxGridCellAttr::GetBackgroundColour() const
2823 {
2824 if (HasBackgroundColour())
2825 {
2826 return m_colBack;
2827 }
2828 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2829 {
2830 return m_defGridAttr->GetBackgroundColour();
2831 }
2832 else
2833 {
2834 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2835 return wxNullColour;
2836 }
2837 }
2838
2839 const wxFont& wxGridCellAttr::GetFont() const
2840 {
2841 if (HasFont())
2842 {
2843 return m_font;
2844 }
2845 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2846 {
2847 return m_defGridAttr->GetFont();
2848 }
2849 else
2850 {
2851 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2852 return wxNullFont;
2853 }
2854 }
2855
2856 void wxGridCellAttr::GetAlignment(int *hAlign, int *vAlign) const
2857 {
2858 if (HasAlignment())
2859 {
2860 if ( hAlign )
2861 *hAlign = m_hAlign;
2862 if ( vAlign )
2863 *vAlign = m_vAlign;
2864 }
2865 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2866 {
2867 m_defGridAttr->GetAlignment(hAlign, vAlign);
2868 }
2869 else
2870 {
2871 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2872 }
2873 }
2874
2875 void wxGridCellAttr::GetSize( int *num_rows, int *num_cols ) const
2876 {
2877 if ( num_rows )
2878 *num_rows = m_sizeRows;
2879 if ( num_cols )
2880 *num_cols = m_sizeCols;
2881 }
2882
2883 // GetRenderer and GetEditor use a slightly different decision path about
2884 // which attribute to use. If a non-default attr object has one then it is
2885 // used, otherwise the default editor or renderer is fetched from the grid and
2886 // used. It should be the default for the data type of the cell. If it is
2887 // NULL (because the table has a type that the grid does not have in its
2888 // registry), then the grid's default editor or renderer is used.
2889
2890 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGridCellAttr::GetRenderer(const wxGrid* grid, int row, int col) const
2891 {
2892 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = NULL;
2893
2894 if ( m_renderer && this != m_defGridAttr )
2895 {
2896 // use the cells renderer if it has one
2897 renderer = m_renderer;
2898 renderer->IncRef();
2899 }
2900 else // no non-default cell renderer
2901 {
2902 // get default renderer for the data type
2903 if ( grid )
2904 {
2905 // GetDefaultRendererForCell() will do IncRef() for us
2906 renderer = grid->GetDefaultRendererForCell(row, col);
2907 }
2908
2909 if ( renderer == NULL )
2910 {
2911 if ( (m_defGridAttr != NULL) && (m_defGridAttr != this) )
2912 {
2913 // if we still don't have one then use the grid default
2914 // (no need for IncRef() here neither)
2915 renderer = m_defGridAttr->GetRenderer(NULL, 0, 0);
2916 }
2917 else // default grid attr
2918 {
2919 // use m_renderer which we had decided not to use initially
2920 renderer = m_renderer;
2921 if ( renderer )
2922 renderer->IncRef();
2923 }
2924 }
2925 }
2926
2927 // we're supposed to always find something
2928 wxASSERT_MSG(renderer, wxT("Missing default cell renderer"));
2929
2930 return renderer;
2931 }
2932
2933 // same as above, except for s/renderer/editor/g
2934 wxGridCellEditor* wxGridCellAttr::GetEditor(const wxGrid* grid, int row, int col) const
2935 {
2936 wxGridCellEditor *editor = NULL;
2937
2938 if ( m_editor && this != m_defGridAttr )
2939 {
2940 // use the cells editor if it has one
2941 editor = m_editor;
2942 editor->IncRef();
2943 }
2944 else // no non default cell editor
2945 {
2946 // get default editor for the data type
2947 if ( grid )
2948 {
2949 // GetDefaultEditorForCell() will do IncRef() for us
2950 editor = grid->GetDefaultEditorForCell(row, col);
2951 }
2952
2953 if ( editor == NULL )
2954 {
2955 if ( (m_defGridAttr != NULL) && (m_defGridAttr != this) )
2956 {
2957 // if we still don't have one then use the grid default
2958 // (no need for IncRef() here neither)
2959 editor = m_defGridAttr->GetEditor(NULL, 0, 0);
2960 }
2961 else // default grid attr
2962 {
2963 // use m_editor which we had decided not to use initially
2964 editor = m_editor;
2965 if ( editor )
2966 editor->IncRef();
2967 }
2968 }
2969 }
2970
2971 // we're supposed to always find something
2972 wxASSERT_MSG(editor, wxT("Missing default cell editor"));
2973
2974 return editor;
2975 }
2976
2977 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2978 // wxGridCellAttrData
2979 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2980
2981 void wxGridCellAttrData::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row, int col)
2982 {
2983 // Note: contrary to wxGridRowOrColAttrData::SetAttr, we must not
2984 // touch attribute's reference counting explicitly, since this
2985 // is managed by class wxGridCellWithAttr
2986 int n = FindIndex(row, col);
2987 if ( n == wxNOT_FOUND )
2988 {
2989 if ( attr )
2990 {
2991 // add the attribute
2992 m_attrs.Add(new wxGridCellWithAttr(row, col, attr));
2993 }
2994 //else: nothing to do
2995 }
2996 else // we already have an attribute for this cell
2997 {
2998 if ( attr )
2999 {
3000 // change the attribute
3001 m_attrs[(size_t)n].ChangeAttr(attr);
3002 }
3003 else
3004 {
3005 // remove this attribute
3006 m_attrs.RemoveAt((size_t)n);
3007 }
3008 }
3009 }
3010
3011 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttrData::GetAttr(int row, int col) const
3012 {
3013 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
3014
3015 int n = FindIndex(row, col);
3016 if ( n != wxNOT_FOUND )
3017 {
3018 attr = m_attrs[(size_t)n].attr;
3019 attr->IncRef();
3020 }
3021
3022 return attr;
3023 }
3024
3025 void wxGridCellAttrData::UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows )
3026 {
3027 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
3028 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
3029 {
3030 wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
3031 wxCoord row = coords.GetRow();
3032 if ((size_t)row >= pos)
3033 {
3034 if (numRows > 0)
3035 {
3036 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
3037 coords.SetRow(row + numRows);
3038 }
3039 else if (numRows < 0)
3040 {
3041 // If rows deleted ...
3042 if ((size_t)row >= pos - numRows)
3043 {
3044 // ...either decrement row counter (if row still exists)...
3045 coords.SetRow(row + numRows);
3046 }
3047 else
3048 {
3049 // ...or remove the attribute
3050 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
3051 n--;
3052 count--;
3053 }
3054 }
3055 }
3056 }
3057 }
3058
3059 void wxGridCellAttrData::UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols )
3060 {
3061 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
3062 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
3063 {
3064 wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
3065 wxCoord col = coords.GetCol();
3066 if ( (size_t)col >= pos )
3067 {
3068 if ( numCols > 0 )
3069 {
3070 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
3071 coords.SetCol(col + numCols);
3072 }
3073 else if (numCols < 0)
3074 {
3075 // If rows deleted ...
3076 if ((size_t)col >= pos - numCols)
3077 {
3078 // ...either decrement row counter (if row still exists)...
3079 coords.SetCol(col + numCols);
3080 }
3081 else
3082 {
3083 // ...or remove the attribute
3084 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
3085 n--;
3086 count--;
3087 }
3088 }
3089 }
3090 }
3091 }
3092
3093 int wxGridCellAttrData::FindIndex(int row, int col) const
3094 {
3095 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
3096 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
3097 {
3098 const wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
3099 if ( (coords.GetRow() == row) && (coords.GetCol() == col) )
3100 {
3101 return n;
3102 }
3103 }
3104
3105 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3106 }
3107
3108 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3109 // wxGridRowOrColAttrData
3110 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3111
3112 wxGridRowOrColAttrData::~wxGridRowOrColAttrData()
3113 {
3114 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
3115 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
3116 {
3117 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
3118 }
3119 }
3120
3121 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridRowOrColAttrData::GetAttr(int rowOrCol) const
3122 {
3123 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
3124
3125 int n = m_rowsOrCols.Index(rowOrCol);
3126 if ( n != wxNOT_FOUND )
3127 {
3128 attr = m_attrs[(size_t)n];
3129 attr->IncRef();
3130 }
3131
3132 return attr;
3133 }
3134
3135 void wxGridRowOrColAttrData::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int rowOrCol)
3136 {
3137 int i = m_rowsOrCols.Index(rowOrCol);
3138 if ( i == wxNOT_FOUND )
3139 {
3140 if ( attr )
3141 {
3142 // add the attribute - no need to do anything to reference count
3143 // since we take ownership of the attribute.
3144 m_rowsOrCols.Add(rowOrCol);
3145 m_attrs.Add(attr);
3146 }
3147 // nothing to remove
3148 }
3149 else
3150 {
3151 size_t n = (size_t)i;
3152 if ( m_attrs[n] == attr )
3153 // nothing to do
3154 return;
3155 if ( attr )
3156 {
3157 // change the attribute, handling reference count manually,
3158 // taking ownership of the new attribute.
3159 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
3160 m_attrs[n] = attr;
3161 }
3162 else
3163 {
3164 // remove this attribute, handling reference count manually
3165 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
3166 m_rowsOrCols.RemoveAt(n);
3167 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
3168 }
3169 }
3170 }
3171
3172 void wxGridRowOrColAttrData::UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( size_t pos, int numRowsOrCols )
3173 {
3174 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
3175 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
3176 {
3177 int & rowOrCol = m_rowsOrCols[n];
3178 if ( (size_t)rowOrCol >= pos )
3179 {
3180 if ( numRowsOrCols > 0 )
3181 {
3182 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
3183 rowOrCol += numRowsOrCols;
3184 }
3185 else if ( numRowsOrCols < 0)
3186 {
3187 // If rows deleted, either decrement row counter (if row still exists)
3188 if ((size_t)rowOrCol >= pos - numRowsOrCols)
3189 rowOrCol += numRowsOrCols;
3190 else
3191 {
3192 m_rowsOrCols.RemoveAt(n);
3193 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
3194 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
3195 n--;
3196 count--;
3197 }
3198 }
3199 }
3200 }
3201 }
3202
3203 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3204 // wxGridCellAttrProvider
3205 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3206
3207 wxGridCellAttrProvider::wxGridCellAttrProvider()
3208 {
3209 m_data = NULL;
3210 }
3211
3212 wxGridCellAttrProvider::~wxGridCellAttrProvider()
3213 {
3214 delete m_data;
3215 }
3216
3217 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::InitData()
3218 {
3219 m_data = new wxGridCellAttrProviderData;
3220 }
3221
3222 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttrProvider::GetAttr(int row, int col,
3223 wxGridCellAttr::wxAttrKind kind ) const
3224 {
3225 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
3226 if ( m_data )
3227 {
3228 switch (kind)
3229 {
3230 case (wxGridCellAttr::Any):
3231 // Get cached merge attributes.
3232 // Currently not used as no cache implemented as not mutable
3233 // attr = m_data->m_mergeAttr.GetAttr(row, col);
3234 if (!attr)
3235 {
3236 // Basically implement old version.
3237 // Also check merge cache, so we don't have to re-merge every time..
3238 wxGridCellAttr *attrcell = m_data->m_cellAttrs.GetAttr(row, col);
3239 wxGridCellAttr *attrrow = m_data->m_rowAttrs.GetAttr(row);
3240 wxGridCellAttr *attrcol = m_data->m_colAttrs.GetAttr(col);
3241
3242 if ((attrcell != attrrow) && (attrrow != attrcol) && (attrcell != attrcol))
3243 {
3244 // Two or more are non NULL
3245 attr = new wxGridCellAttr;
3246 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Merged);
3247
3248 // Order is important..
3249 if (attrcell)
3250 {
3251 attr->MergeWith(attrcell);
3252 attrcell->DecRef();
3253 }
3254 if (attrcol)
3255 {
3256 attr->MergeWith(attrcol);
3257 attrcol->DecRef();
3258 }
3259 if (attrrow)
3260 {
3261 attr->MergeWith(attrrow);
3262 attrrow->DecRef();
3263 }
3264
3265 // store merge attr if cache implemented
3266 //attr->IncRef();
3267 //m_data->m_mergeAttr.SetAttr(attr, row, col);
3268 }
3269 else
3270 {
3271 // one or none is non null return it or null.
3272 if (attrrow)
3273 attr = attrrow;
3274 if (attrcol)
3275 {
3276 if (attr)
3277 attr->DecRef();
3278 attr = attrcol;
3279 }
3280 if (attrcell)
3281 {
3282 if (attr)
3283 attr->DecRef();
3284 attr = attrcell;
3285 }
3286 }
3287 }
3288 break;
3289
3290 case (wxGridCellAttr::Cell):
3291 attr = m_data->m_cellAttrs.GetAttr(row, col);
3292 break;
3293
3294 case (wxGridCellAttr::Col):
3295 attr = m_data->m_colAttrs.GetAttr(col);
3296 break;
3297
3298 case (wxGridCellAttr::Row):
3299 attr = m_data->m_rowAttrs.GetAttr(row);
3300 break;
3301
3302 default:
3303 // unused as yet...
3304 // (wxGridCellAttr::Default):
3305 // (wxGridCellAttr::Merged):
3306 break;
3307 }
3308 }
3309
3310 return attr;
3311 }
3312
3313 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr,
3314 int row, int col)
3315 {
3316 if ( !m_data )
3317 InitData();
3318
3319 m_data->m_cellAttrs.SetAttr(attr, row, col);
3320 }
3321
3322 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetRowAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row)
3323 {
3324 if ( !m_data )
3325 InitData();
3326
3327 m_data->m_rowAttrs.SetAttr(attr, row);
3328 }
3329
3330 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetColAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int col)
3331 {
3332 if ( !m_data )
3333 InitData();
3334
3335 m_data->m_colAttrs.SetAttr(attr, col);
3336 }
3337
3338 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows )
3339 {
3340 if ( m_data )
3341 {
3342 m_data->m_cellAttrs.UpdateAttrRows( pos, numRows );
3343
3344 m_data->m_rowAttrs.UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( pos, numRows );
3345 }
3346 }
3347
3348 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols )
3349 {
3350 if ( m_data )
3351 {
3352 m_data->m_cellAttrs.UpdateAttrCols( pos, numCols );
3353
3354 m_data->m_colAttrs.UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( pos, numCols );
3355 }
3356 }
3357
3358 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3359 // wxGridTypeRegistry
3360 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3361
3362 wxGridTypeRegistry::~wxGridTypeRegistry()
3363 {
3364 size_t count = m_typeinfo.GetCount();
3365 for ( size_t i = 0; i < count; i++ )
3366 delete m_typeinfo[i];
3367 }
3368
3369 void wxGridTypeRegistry::RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
3370 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
3371 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
3372 {
3373 wxGridDataTypeInfo* info = new wxGridDataTypeInfo(typeName, renderer, editor);
3374
3375 // is it already registered?
3376 int loc = FindRegisteredDataType(typeName);
3377 if ( loc != wxNOT_FOUND )
3378 {
3379 delete m_typeinfo[loc];
3380 m_typeinfo[loc] = info;
3381 }
3382 else
3383 {
3384 m_typeinfo.Add(info);
3385 }
3386 }
3387
3388 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindRegisteredDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3389 {
3390 size_t count = m_typeinfo.GetCount();
3391 for ( size_t i = 0; i < count; i++ )
3392 {
3393 if ( typeName == m_typeinfo[i]->m_typeName )
3394 {
3395 return i;
3396 }
3397 }
3398
3399 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3400 }
3401
3402 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3403 {
3404 int index = FindRegisteredDataType(typeName);
3405 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3406 {
3407 // check whether this is one of the standard ones, in which case
3408 // register it "on the fly"
3409 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3410 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_STRING )
3411 {
3412 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
3413 new wxGridCellStringRenderer,
3414 new wxGridCellTextEditor);
3415 }
3416 else
3417 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3418 #if wxUSE_CHECKBOX
3419 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL )
3420 {
3421 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL,
3422 new wxGridCellBoolRenderer,
3423 new wxGridCellBoolEditor);
3424 }
3425 else
3426 #endif // wxUSE_CHECKBOX
3427 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3428 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER )
3429 {
3430 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER,
3431 new wxGridCellNumberRenderer,
3432 new wxGridCellNumberEditor);
3433 }
3434 else if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT )
3435 {
3436 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT,
3437 new wxGridCellFloatRenderer,
3438 new wxGridCellFloatEditor);
3439 }
3440 else
3441 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3442 #if wxUSE_COMBOBOX
3443 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_CHOICE )
3444 {
3445 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_CHOICE,
3446 new wxGridCellStringRenderer,
3447 new wxGridCellChoiceEditor);
3448 }
3449 else
3450 #endif // wxUSE_COMBOBOX
3451 {
3452 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3453 }
3454
3455 // we get here only if just added the entry for this type, so return
3456 // the last index
3457 index = m_typeinfo.GetCount() - 1;
3458 }
3459
3460 return index;
3461 }
3462
3463 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindOrCloneDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3464 {
3465 int index = FindDataType(typeName);
3466 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3467 {
3468 // the first part of the typename is the "real" type, anything after ':'
3469 // are the parameters for the renderer
3470 index = FindDataType(typeName.BeforeFirst(_T(':')));
3471 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3472 {
3473 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3474 }
3475
3476 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = GetRenderer(index);
3477 wxGridCellRenderer *rendererOld = renderer;
3478 renderer = renderer->Clone();
3479 rendererOld->DecRef();
3480
3481 wxGridCellEditor *editor = GetEditor(index);
3482 wxGridCellEditor *editorOld = editor;
3483 editor = editor->Clone();
3484 editorOld->DecRef();
3485
3486 // do it even if there are no parameters to reset them to defaults
3487 wxString params = typeName.AfterFirst(_T(':'));
3488 renderer->SetParameters(params);
3489 editor->SetParameters(params);
3490
3491 // register the new typename
3492 RegisterDataType(typeName, renderer, editor);
3493
3494 // we just registered it, it's the last one
3495 index = m_typeinfo.GetCount() - 1;
3496 }
3497
3498 return index;
3499 }
3500
3501 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGridTypeRegistry::GetRenderer(int index)
3502 {
3503 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer = m_typeinfo[index]->m_renderer;
3504 if (renderer)
3505 renderer->IncRef();
3506
3507 return renderer;
3508 }
3509
3510 wxGridCellEditor* wxGridTypeRegistry::GetEditor(int index)
3511 {
3512 wxGridCellEditor* editor = m_typeinfo[index]->m_editor;
3513 if (editor)
3514 editor->IncRef();
3515
3516 return editor;
3517 }
3518
3519 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3520 // wxGridTableBase
3521 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3522
3523 IMPLEMENT_ABSTRACT_CLASS( wxGridTableBase, wxObject )
3524
3525 wxGridTableBase::wxGridTableBase()
3526 {
3527 m_view = NULL;
3528 m_attrProvider = NULL;
3529 }
3530
3531 wxGridTableBase::~wxGridTableBase()
3532 {
3533 delete m_attrProvider;
3534 }
3535
3536 void wxGridTableBase::SetAttrProvider(wxGridCellAttrProvider *attrProvider)
3537 {
3538 delete m_attrProvider;
3539 m_attrProvider = attrProvider;
3540 }
3541
3542 bool wxGridTableBase::CanHaveAttributes()
3543 {
3544 if ( ! GetAttrProvider() )
3545 {
3546 // use the default attr provider by default
3547 SetAttrProvider(new wxGridCellAttrProvider);
3548 }
3549
3550 return true;
3551 }
3552
3553 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridTableBase::GetAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr::wxAttrKind kind)
3554 {
3555 if ( m_attrProvider )
3556 return m_attrProvider->GetAttr(row, col, kind);
3557 else
3558 return NULL;
3559 }
3560
3561 void wxGridTableBase::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr* attr, int row, int col)
3562 {
3563 if ( m_attrProvider )
3564 {
3565 if ( attr )
3566 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Cell);
3567 m_attrProvider->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
3568 }
3569 else
3570 {
3571 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3572 // free it now
3573 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3574 }
3575 }
3576
3577 void wxGridTableBase::SetRowAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row)
3578 {
3579 if ( m_attrProvider )
3580 {
3581 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Row);
3582 m_attrProvider->SetRowAttr(attr, row);
3583 }
3584 else
3585 {
3586 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3587 // free it now
3588 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3589 }
3590 }
3591
3592 void wxGridTableBase::SetColAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int col)
3593 {
3594 if ( m_attrProvider )
3595 {
3596 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Col);
3597 m_attrProvider->SetColAttr(attr, col);
3598 }
3599 else
3600 {
3601 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3602 // free it now
3603 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3604 }
3605 }
3606
3607 bool wxGridTableBase::InsertRows( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3608 size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3609 {
3610 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function InsertRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function") );
3611
3612 return false;
3613 }
3614
3615 bool wxGridTableBase::AppendRows( size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3616 {
3617 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function AppendRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3618
3619 return false;
3620 }
3621
3622 bool wxGridTableBase::DeleteRows( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3623 size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3624 {
3625 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function DeleteRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3626
3627 return false;
3628 }
3629
3630 bool wxGridTableBase::InsertCols( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3631 size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3632 {
3633 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function InsertCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3634
3635 return false;
3636 }
3637
3638 bool wxGridTableBase::AppendCols( size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3639 {
3640 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Called grid table class function AppendCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3641
3642 return false;
3643 }
3644
3645 bool wxGridTableBase::DeleteCols( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3646 size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3647 {
3648 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function DeleteCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3649
3650 return false;
3651 }
3652
3653 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue( int row )
3654 {
3655 wxString s;
3656
3657 // RD: Starting the rows at zero confuses users,
3658 // no matter how much it makes sense to us geeks.
3659 s << row + 1;
3660
3661 return s;
3662 }
3663
3664 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( int col )
3665 {
3666 // default col labels are:
3667 // cols 0 to 25 : A-Z
3668 // cols 26 to 675 : AA-ZZ
3669 // etc.
3670
3671 wxString s;
3672 unsigned int i, n;
3673 for ( n = 1; ; n++ )
3674 {
3675 s += (wxChar) (_T('A') + (wxChar)(col % 26));
3676 col = col / 26 - 1;
3677 if ( col < 0 )
3678 break;
3679 }
3680
3681 // reverse the string...
3682 wxString s2;
3683 for ( i = 0; i < n; i++ )
3684 {
3685 s2 += s[n - i - 1];
3686 }
3687
3688 return s2;
3689 }
3690
3691 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetTypeName( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3692 {
3693 return wxGRID_VALUE_STRING;
3694 }
3695
3696 bool wxGridTableBase::CanGetValueAs( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3697 const wxString& typeName )
3698 {
3699 return typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_STRING;
3700 }
3701
3702 bool wxGridTableBase::CanSetValueAs( int row, int col, const wxString& typeName )
3703 {
3704 return CanGetValueAs(row, col, typeName);
3705 }
3706
3707 long wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsLong( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3708 {
3709 return 0;
3710 }
3711
3712 double wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsDouble( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3713 {
3714 return 0.0;
3715 }
3716
3717 bool wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsBool( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3718 {
3719 return false;
3720 }
3721
3722 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsLong( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3723 long WXUNUSED(value) )
3724 {
3725 }
3726
3727 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsDouble( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3728 double WXUNUSED(value) )
3729 {
3730 }
3731
3732 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsBool( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3733 bool WXUNUSED(value) )
3734 {
3735 }
3736
3737 void* wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsCustom( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3738 const wxString& WXUNUSED(typeName) )
3739 {
3740 return NULL;
3741 }
3742
3743 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsCustom( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3744 const wxString& WXUNUSED(typeName),
3745 void* WXUNUSED(value) )
3746 {
3747 }
3748
3749 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3750 //
3751 // Message class for the grid table to send requests and notifications
3752 // to the grid view
3753 //
3754
3755 wxGridTableMessage::wxGridTableMessage()
3756 {
3757 m_table = NULL;
3758 m_id = -1;
3759 m_comInt1 = -1;
3760 m_comInt2 = -1;
3761 }
3762
3763 wxGridTableMessage::wxGridTableMessage( wxGridTableBase *table, int id,
3764 int commandInt1, int commandInt2 )
3765 {
3766 m_table = table;
3767 m_id = id;
3768 m_comInt1 = commandInt1;
3769 m_comInt2 = commandInt2;
3770 }
3771
3772 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3773 //
3774 // A basic grid table for string data. An object of this class will
3775 // created by wxGrid if you don't specify an alternative table class.
3776 //
3777
3778 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridStringArray)
3779
3780 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridStringTable, wxGridTableBase )
3781
3782 wxGridStringTable::wxGridStringTable()
3783 : wxGridTableBase()
3784 {
3785 }
3786
3787 wxGridStringTable::wxGridStringTable( int numRows, int numCols )
3788 : wxGridTableBase()
3789 {
3790 m_data.Alloc( numRows );
3791
3792 wxArrayString sa;
3793 sa.Alloc( numCols );
3794 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, numCols );
3795
3796 m_data.Add( sa, numRows );
3797 }
3798
3799 wxGridStringTable::~wxGridStringTable()
3800 {
3801 }
3802
3803 int wxGridStringTable::GetNumberRows()
3804 {
3805 return m_data.GetCount();
3806 }
3807
3808 int wxGridStringTable::GetNumberCols()
3809 {
3810 if ( m_data.GetCount() > 0 )
3811 return m_data[0].GetCount();
3812 else
3813 return 0;
3814 }
3815
3816 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetValue( int row, int col )
3817 {
3818 wxCHECK_MSG( (row < GetNumberRows()) && (col < GetNumberCols()),
3819 wxEmptyString,
3820 _T("invalid row or column index in wxGridStringTable") );
3821
3822 return m_data[row][col];
3823 }
3824
3825 void wxGridStringTable::SetValue( int row, int col, const wxString& value )
3826 {
3827 wxCHECK_RET( (row < GetNumberRows()) && (col < GetNumberCols()),
3828 _T("invalid row or column index in wxGridStringTable") );
3829
3830 m_data[row][col] = value;
3831 }
3832
3833 void wxGridStringTable::Clear()
3834 {
3835 int row, col;
3836 int numRows, numCols;
3837
3838 numRows = m_data.GetCount();
3839 if ( numRows > 0 )
3840 {
3841 numCols = m_data[0].GetCount();
3842
3843 for ( row = 0; row < numRows; row++ )
3844 {
3845 for ( col = 0; col < numCols; col++ )
3846 {
3847 m_data[row][col] = wxEmptyString;
3848 }
3849 }
3850 }
3851 }
3852
3853 bool wxGridStringTable::InsertRows( size_t pos, size_t numRows )
3854 {
3855 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3856 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0 ? m_data[0].GetCount() :
3857 ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3858
3859 if ( pos >= curNumRows )
3860 {
3861 return AppendRows( numRows );
3862 }
3863
3864 wxArrayString sa;
3865 sa.Alloc( curNumCols );
3866 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, curNumCols );
3867 m_data.Insert( sa, pos, numRows );
3868
3869 if ( GetView() )
3870 {
3871 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3872 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED,
3873 pos,
3874 numRows );
3875
3876 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3877 }
3878
3879 return true;
3880 }
3881
3882 bool wxGridStringTable::AppendRows( size_t numRows )
3883 {
3884 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3885 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0
3886 ? m_data[0].GetCount()
3887 : ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3888
3889 wxArrayString sa;
3890 if ( curNumCols > 0 )
3891 {
3892 sa.Alloc( curNumCols );
3893 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, curNumCols );
3894 }
3895
3896 m_data.Add( sa, numRows );
3897
3898 if ( GetView() )
3899 {
3900 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3901 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED,
3902 numRows );
3903
3904 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3905 }
3906
3907 return true;
3908 }
3909
3910 bool wxGridStringTable::DeleteRows( size_t pos, size_t numRows )
3911 {
3912 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3913
3914 if ( pos >= curNumRows )
3915 {
3916 wxFAIL_MSG( wxString::Format
3917 (
3918 wxT("Called wxGridStringTable::DeleteRows(pos=%lu, N=%lu)\nPos value is invalid for present table with %lu rows"),
3919 (unsigned long)pos,
3920 (unsigned long)numRows,
3921 (unsigned long)curNumRows
3922 ) );
3923
3924 return false;
3925 }
3926
3927 if ( numRows > curNumRows - pos )
3928 {
3929 numRows = curNumRows - pos;
3930 }
3931
3932 if ( numRows >= curNumRows )
3933 {
3934 m_data.Clear();
3935 }
3936 else
3937 {
3938 m_data.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
3939 }
3940
3941 if ( GetView() )
3942 {
3943 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3944 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED,
3945 pos,
3946 numRows );
3947
3948 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3949 }
3950
3951 return true;
3952 }
3953
3954 bool wxGridStringTable::InsertCols( size_t pos, size_t numCols )
3955 {
3956 size_t row, col;
3957
3958 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3959 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0
3960 ? m_data[0].GetCount()
3961 : ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3962
3963 if ( pos >= curNumCols )
3964 {
3965 return AppendCols( numCols );
3966 }
3967
3968 if ( !m_colLabels.IsEmpty() )
3969 {
3970 m_colLabels.Insert( wxEmptyString, pos, numCols );
3971
3972 size_t i;
3973 for ( i = pos; i < pos + numCols; i++ )
3974 m_colLabels[i] = wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( i );
3975 }
3976
3977 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
3978 {
3979 for ( col = pos; col < pos + numCols; col++ )
3980 {
3981 m_data[row].Insert( wxEmptyString, col );
3982 }
3983 }
3984
3985 if ( GetView() )
3986 {
3987 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3988 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED,
3989 pos,
3990 numCols );
3991
3992 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3993 }
3994
3995 return true;
3996 }
3997
3998 bool wxGridStringTable::AppendCols( size_t numCols )
3999 {
4000 size_t row;
4001
4002 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
4003
4004 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
4005 {
4006 m_data[row].Add( wxEmptyString, numCols );
4007 }
4008
4009 if ( GetView() )
4010 {
4011 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
4012 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED,
4013 numCols );
4014
4015 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
4016 }
4017
4018 return true;
4019 }
4020
4021 bool wxGridStringTable::DeleteCols( size_t pos, size_t numCols )
4022 {
4023 size_t row;
4024
4025 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
4026 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0 ? m_data[0].GetCount() :
4027 ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
4028
4029 if ( pos >= curNumCols )
4030 {
4031 wxFAIL_MSG( wxString::Format
4032 (
4033 wxT("Called wxGridStringTable::DeleteCols(pos=%lu, N=%lu)\nPos value is invalid for present table with %lu cols"),
4034 (unsigned long)pos,
4035 (unsigned long)numCols,
4036 (unsigned long)curNumCols
4037 ) );
4038 return false;
4039 }
4040
4041 int colID;
4042 if ( GetView() )
4043 colID = GetView()->GetColAt( pos );
4044 else
4045 colID = pos;
4046
4047 if ( numCols > curNumCols - colID )
4048 {
4049 numCols = curNumCols - colID;
4050 }
4051
4052 if ( !m_colLabels.IsEmpty() )
4053 {
4054 // m_colLabels stores just as many elements as it needs, e.g. if only
4055 // the label of the first column had been set it would have only one
4056 // element and not numCols, so account for it
4057 int nToRm = m_colLabels.size() - colID;
4058 if ( nToRm > 0 )
4059 m_colLabels.RemoveAt( colID, nToRm );
4060 }
4061
4062 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
4063 {
4064 if ( numCols >= curNumCols )
4065 {
4066 m_data[row].Clear();
4067 }
4068 else
4069 {
4070 m_data[row].RemoveAt( colID, numCols );
4071 }
4072 }
4073
4074 if ( GetView() )
4075 {
4076 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
4077 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED,
4078 pos,
4079 numCols );
4080
4081 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
4082 }
4083
4084 return true;
4085 }
4086
4087 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetRowLabelValue( int row )
4088 {
4089 if ( row > (int)(m_rowLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
4090 {
4091 // using default label
4092 //
4093 return wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue( row );
4094 }
4095 else
4096 {
4097 return m_rowLabels[row];
4098 }
4099 }
4100
4101 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetColLabelValue( int col )
4102 {
4103 if ( col > (int)(m_colLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
4104 {
4105 // using default label
4106 //
4107 return wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( col );
4108 }
4109 else
4110 {
4111 return m_colLabels[col];
4112 }
4113 }
4114
4115 void wxGridStringTable::SetRowLabelValue( int row, const wxString& value )
4116 {
4117 if ( row > (int)(m_rowLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
4118 {
4119 int n = m_rowLabels.GetCount();
4120 int i;
4121
4122 for ( i = n; i <= row; i++ )
4123 {
4124 m_rowLabels.Add( wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue(i) );
4125 }
4126 }
4127
4128 m_rowLabels[row] = value;
4129 }
4130
4131 void wxGridStringTable::SetColLabelValue( int col, const wxString& value )
4132 {
4133 if ( col > (int)(m_colLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
4134 {
4135 int n = m_colLabels.GetCount();
4136 int i;
4137
4138 for ( i = n; i <= col; i++ )
4139 {
4140 m_colLabels.Add( wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue(i) );
4141 }
4142 }
4143
4144 m_colLabels[col] = value;
4145 }
4146
4147
4148 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4149 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4150
4151 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE(wxGridSubwindow, wxWindow)
4152 EVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_LOST(wxGridSubwindow::OnMouseCaptureLost)
4153 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4154
4155 void wxGridSubwindow::OnMouseCaptureLost(wxMouseCaptureLostEvent& WXUNUSED(event))
4156 {
4157 m_owner->CancelMouseCapture();
4158 }
4159
4160 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridRowLabelWindow, wxWindow )
4161
4162 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridRowLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
4163 EVT_PAINT( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnPaint )
4164 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
4165 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
4166 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4167
4168 wxGridRowLabelWindow::wxGridRowLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
4169 wxWindowID id,
4170 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size )
4171 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
4172 {
4173 m_owner = parent;
4174 }
4175
4176 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
4177 {
4178 wxPaintDC dc(this);
4179
4180 // NO - don't do this because it will set both the x and y origin
4181 // coords to match the parent scrolled window and we just want to
4182 // set the y coord - MB
4183 //
4184 // m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
4185
4186 int x, y;
4187 m_owner->CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &x, &y );
4188 wxPoint pt = dc.GetDeviceOrigin();
4189 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x, pt.y-y );
4190
4191 wxArrayInt rows = m_owner->CalcRowLabelsExposed( GetUpdateRegion() );
4192 m_owner->DrawRowLabels( dc, rows );
4193 }
4194
4195 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
4196 {
4197 m_owner->ProcessRowLabelMouseEvent( event );
4198 }
4199
4200 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
4201 {
4202 if (!m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ))
4203 event.Skip();
4204 }
4205
4206 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4207
4208 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridColLabelWindow, wxWindow )
4209
4210 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridColLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
4211 EVT_PAINT( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnPaint )
4212 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
4213 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
4214 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4215
4216 wxGridColLabelWindow::wxGridColLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
4217 wxWindowID id,
4218 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size )
4219 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
4220 {
4221 m_owner = parent;
4222 }
4223
4224 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
4225 {
4226 wxPaintDC dc(this);
4227
4228 // NO - don't do this because it will set both the x and y origin
4229 // coords to match the parent scrolled window and we just want to
4230 // set the x coord - MB
4231 //
4232 // m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
4233
4234 int x, y;
4235 m_owner->CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &x, &y );
4236 wxPoint pt = dc.GetDeviceOrigin();
4237 if (GetLayoutDirection() == wxLayout_RightToLeft)
4238 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x+x, pt.y );
4239 else
4240 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x-x, pt.y );
4241
4242 wxArrayInt cols = m_owner->CalcColLabelsExposed( GetUpdateRegion() );
4243 m_owner->DrawColLabels( dc, cols );
4244 }
4245
4246 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
4247 {
4248 m_owner->ProcessColLabelMouseEvent( event );
4249 }
4250
4251 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
4252 {
4253 if (!m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ))
4254 event.Skip();
4255 }
4256
4257 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4258
4259 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridCornerLabelWindow, wxWindow )
4260
4261 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridCornerLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
4262 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
4263 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
4264 EVT_PAINT( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnPaint )
4265 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4266
4267 wxGridCornerLabelWindow::wxGridCornerLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
4268 wxWindowID id,
4269 const wxPoint& pos,
4270 const wxSize& size )
4271 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
4272 {
4273 m_owner = parent;
4274 }
4275
4276 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
4277 {
4278 wxPaintDC dc(this);
4279
4280 m_owner->DrawCornerLabel(dc);
4281 }
4282
4283 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
4284 {
4285 m_owner->ProcessCornerLabelMouseEvent( event );
4286 }
4287
4288 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
4289 {
4290 if (!m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event))
4291 event.Skip();
4292 }
4293
4294 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4295
4296 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridWindow, wxWindow )
4297
4298 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
4299 EVT_PAINT( wxGridWindow::OnPaint )
4300 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridWindow::OnMouseWheel )
4301 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridWindow::OnMouseEvent )
4302 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGridWindow::OnKeyDown )
4303 EVT_KEY_UP( wxGridWindow::OnKeyUp )
4304 EVT_CHAR( wxGridWindow::OnChar )
4305 EVT_SET_FOCUS( wxGridWindow::OnFocus )
4306 EVT_KILL_FOCUS( wxGridWindow::OnFocus )
4307 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND( wxGridWindow::OnEraseBackground )
4308 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4309
4310 wxGridWindow::wxGridWindow( wxGrid *parent,
4311 wxGridRowLabelWindow *rowLblWin,
4312 wxGridColLabelWindow *colLblWin,
4313 wxWindowID id,
4314 const wxPoint &pos,
4315 const wxSize &size )
4316 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size,
4317 wxWANTS_CHARS | wxCLIP_CHILDREN,
4318 wxT("grid window") )
4319 {
4320 m_owner = parent;
4321 m_rowLabelWin = rowLblWin;
4322 m_colLabelWin = colLblWin;
4323 }
4324
4325 void wxGridWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent &WXUNUSED(event) )
4326 {
4327 wxPaintDC dc( this );
4328 m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
4329 wxRegion reg = GetUpdateRegion();
4330 wxGridCellCoordsArray dirtyCells = m_owner->CalcCellsExposed( reg );
4331 m_owner->DrawGridCellArea( dc, dirtyCells );
4332
4333 m_owner->DrawGridSpace( dc );
4334
4335 m_owner->DrawAllGridLines( dc, reg );
4336
4337 m_owner->DrawHighlight( dc, dirtyCells );
4338 }
4339
4340 void wxGridWindow::ScrollWindow( int dx, int dy, const wxRect *rect )
4341 {
4342 wxWindow::ScrollWindow( dx, dy, rect );
4343 m_rowLabelWin->ScrollWindow( 0, dy, rect );
4344 m_colLabelWin->ScrollWindow( dx, 0, rect );
4345 }
4346
4347 void wxGridWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
4348 {
4349 if (event.ButtonDown(wxMOUSE_BTN_LEFT) && FindFocus() != this)
4350 SetFocus();
4351
4352 m_owner->ProcessGridCellMouseEvent( event );
4353 }
4354
4355 void wxGridWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
4356 {
4357 if (!m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ))
4358 event.Skip();
4359 }
4360
4361 // This seems to be required for wxMotif/wxGTK otherwise the mouse
4362 // cursor must be in the cell edit control to get key events
4363 //
4364 void wxGridWindow::OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& event )
4365 {
4366 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4367 event.Skip();
4368 }
4369
4370 void wxGridWindow::OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& event )
4371 {
4372 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4373 event.Skip();
4374 }
4375
4376 void wxGridWindow::OnChar( wxKeyEvent& event )
4377 {
4378 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4379 event.Skip();
4380 }
4381
4382 void wxGridWindow::OnEraseBackground( wxEraseEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
4383 {
4384 }
4385
4386 void wxGridWindow::OnFocus(wxFocusEvent& event)
4387 {
4388 // and if we have any selection, it has to be repainted, because it
4389 // uses different colour when the grid is not focused:
4390 if ( m_owner->IsSelection() )
4391 {
4392 Refresh();
4393 }
4394 else
4395 {
4396 // NB: Note that this code is in "else" branch only because the other
4397 // branch refreshes everything and so there's no point in calling
4398 // Refresh() again, *not* because it should only be done if
4399 // !IsSelection(). If the above code is ever optimized to refresh
4400 // only selected area, this needs to be moved out of the "else"
4401 // branch so that it's always executed.
4402
4403 // current cell cursor {dis,re}appears on focus change:
4404 const wxGridCellCoords cursorCoords(m_owner->GetGridCursorRow(),
4405 m_owner->GetGridCursorCol());
4406 const wxRect cursor =
4407 m_owner->BlockToDeviceRect(cursorCoords, cursorCoords);
4408 Refresh(true, &cursor);
4409 }
4410
4411 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4412 event.Skip();
4413 }
4414
4415 #define internalXToCol(x) XToCol(x, true)
4416 #define internalYToRow(y) YToRow(y, true)
4417
4418 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4419
4420 #if wxUSE_EXTENDED_RTTI
4421 WX_DEFINE_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4422
4423 wxBEGIN_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4424 // new style border flags, we put them first to
4425 // use them for streaming out
4426 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SIMPLE)
4427 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SUNKEN)
4428 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_DOUBLE)
4429 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_RAISED)
4430 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_STATIC)
4431 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_NONE)
4432
4433 // old style border flags
4434 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSIMPLE_BORDER)
4435 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSUNKEN_BORDER)
4436 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxDOUBLE_BORDER)
4437 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxRAISED_BORDER)
4438 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSTATIC_BORDER)
4439 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER)
4440
4441 // standard window styles
4442 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTAB_TRAVERSAL)
4443 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxCLIP_CHILDREN)
4444 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTRANSPARENT_WINDOW)
4445 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxWANTS_CHARS)
4446 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxFULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE)
4447 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxALWAYS_SHOW_SB)
4448 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxVSCROLL)
4449 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxHSCROLL)
4450
4451 wxEND_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4452
4453 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS_XTI(wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow,"wx/grid.h")
4454
4455 wxBEGIN_PROPERTIES_TABLE(wxGrid)
4456 wxHIDE_PROPERTY( Children )
4457 wxPROPERTY_FLAGS( WindowStyle , wxGridStyle , long , SetWindowStyleFlag , GetWindowStyleFlag , EMPTY_MACROVALUE, 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // style
4458 wxEND_PROPERTIES_TABLE()
4459
4460 wxBEGIN_HANDLERS_TABLE(wxGrid)
4461 wxEND_HANDLERS_TABLE()
4462
4463 wxCONSTRUCTOR_5( wxGrid , wxWindow* , Parent , wxWindowID , Id , wxPoint , Position , wxSize , Size , long , WindowStyle )
4464
4465 /*
4466 TODO : Expose more information of a list's layout, etc. via appropriate objects (e.g., NotebookPageInfo)
4467 */
4468 #else
4469 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow )
4470 #endif
4471
4472 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow )
4473 EVT_PAINT( wxGrid::OnPaint )
4474 EVT_SIZE( wxGrid::OnSize )
4475 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGrid::OnKeyDown )
4476 EVT_KEY_UP( wxGrid::OnKeyUp )
4477 EVT_CHAR ( wxGrid::OnChar )
4478 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND( wxGrid::OnEraseBackground )
4479 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4480
4481 wxGrid::wxGrid()
4482 {
4483 InitVars();
4484 }
4485
4486 wxGrid::wxGrid( wxWindow *parent,
4487 wxWindowID id,
4488 const wxPoint& pos,
4489 const wxSize& size,
4490 long style,
4491 const wxString& name )
4492 {
4493 InitVars();
4494 Create(parent, id, pos, size, style, name);
4495 }
4496
4497 bool wxGrid::Create(wxWindow *parent, wxWindowID id,
4498 const wxPoint& pos, const wxSize& size,
4499 long style, const wxString& name)
4500 {
4501 if (!wxScrolledWindow::Create(parent, id, pos, size,
4502 style | wxWANTS_CHARS, name))
4503 return false;
4504
4505 m_colMinWidths = wxLongToLongHashMap(GRID_HASH_SIZE);
4506 m_rowMinHeights = wxLongToLongHashMap(GRID_HASH_SIZE);
4507
4508 Create();
4509 SetInitialSize(size);
4510 SetScrollRate(m_scrollLineX, m_scrollLineY);
4511 CalcDimensions();
4512
4513 return true;
4514 }
4515
4516 wxGrid::~wxGrid()
4517 {
4518 if ( m_winCapture )
4519 m_winCapture->ReleaseMouse();
4520
4521 // Ensure that the editor control is destroyed before the grid is,
4522 // otherwise we crash later when the editor tries to do something with the
4523 // half destroyed grid
4524 HideCellEditControl();
4525
4526 // Must do this or ~wxScrollHelper will pop the wrong event handler
4527 SetTargetWindow(this);
4528 ClearAttrCache();
4529 wxSafeDecRef(m_defaultCellAttr);
4530
4531 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
4532 size_t total = gs_nAttrCacheHits + gs_nAttrCacheMisses;
4533 wxPrintf(_T("wxGrid attribute cache statistics: "
4534 "total: %u, hits: %u (%u%%)\n"),
4535 total, gs_nAttrCacheHits,
4536 total ? (gs_nAttrCacheHits*100) / total : 0);
4537 #endif
4538
4539 // if we own the table, just delete it, otherwise at least don't leave it
4540 // with dangling view pointer
4541 if ( m_ownTable )
4542 delete m_table;
4543 else if ( m_table && m_table->GetView() == this )
4544 m_table->SetView(NULL);
4545
4546 delete m_typeRegistry;
4547 delete m_selection;
4548 }
4549
4550 //
4551 // ----- internal init and update functions
4552 //
4553
4554 // NOTE: If using the default visual attributes works everywhere then this can
4555 // be removed as well as the #else cases below.
4556 #define _USE_VISATTR 0
4557
4558 void wxGrid::Create()
4559 {
4560 // create the type registry
4561 m_typeRegistry = new wxGridTypeRegistry;
4562
4563 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = false;
4564
4565 m_defaultCellAttr = new wxGridCellAttr();
4566
4567 // Set default cell attributes
4568 m_defaultCellAttr->SetDefAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
4569 m_defaultCellAttr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Default);
4570 m_defaultCellAttr->SetFont(GetFont());
4571 m_defaultCellAttr->SetAlignment(wxALIGN_LEFT, wxALIGN_TOP);
4572 m_defaultCellAttr->SetRenderer(new wxGridCellStringRenderer);
4573 m_defaultCellAttr->SetEditor(new wxGridCellTextEditor);
4574
4575 #if _USE_VISATTR
4576 wxVisualAttributes gva = wxListBox::GetClassDefaultAttributes();
4577 wxVisualAttributes lva = wxPanel::GetClassDefaultAttributes();
4578
4579 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(gva.colFg);
4580 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(gva.colBg);
4581
4582 #else
4583 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(
4584 wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT));
4585 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(
4586 wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOW));
4587 #endif
4588
4589 m_numRows = 0;
4590 m_numCols = 0;
4591 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4592
4593 m_rowLabelWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_ROW_LABEL_WIDTH;
4594 m_colLabelHeight = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_LABEL_HEIGHT;
4595
4596 // subwindow components that make up the wxGrid
4597 m_rowLabelWin = new wxGridRowLabelWindow( this,
4598 wxID_ANY,
4599 wxDefaultPosition,
4600 wxDefaultSize );
4601
4602 m_colLabelWin = new wxGridColLabelWindow( this,
4603 wxID_ANY,
4604 wxDefaultPosition,
4605 wxDefaultSize );
4606
4607 m_cornerLabelWin = new wxGridCornerLabelWindow( this,
4608 wxID_ANY,
4609 wxDefaultPosition,
4610 wxDefaultSize );
4611
4612 m_gridWin = new wxGridWindow( this,
4613 m_rowLabelWin,
4614 m_colLabelWin,
4615 wxID_ANY,
4616 wxDefaultPosition,
4617 wxDefaultSize );
4618
4619 SetTargetWindow( m_gridWin );
4620
4621 #if _USE_VISATTR
4622 wxColour gfg = gva.colFg;
4623 wxColour gbg = gva.colBg;
4624 wxColour lfg = lva.colFg;
4625 wxColour lbg = lva.colBg;
4626 #else
4627 wxColour gfg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT );
4628 wxColour gbg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOW );
4629 wxColour lfg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT );
4630 wxColour lbg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE );
4631 #endif
4632
4633 m_cornerLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4634 m_cornerLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4635 m_rowLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4636 m_rowLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4637 m_colLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4638 m_colLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4639
4640 m_gridWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(gfg);
4641 m_gridWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(gbg);
4642
4643 Init();
4644 }
4645
4646 bool wxGrid::CreateGrid( int numRows, int numCols,
4647 wxGridSelectionModes selmode )
4648 {
4649 wxCHECK_MSG( !m_created,
4650 false,
4651 wxT("wxGrid::CreateGrid or wxGrid::SetTable called more than once") );
4652
4653 return SetTable(new wxGridStringTable(numRows, numCols), true, selmode);
4654 }
4655
4656 void wxGrid::SetSelectionMode(wxGridSelectionModes selmode)
4657 {
4658 wxCHECK_RET( m_created,
4659 wxT("Called wxGrid::SetSelectionMode() before calling CreateGrid()") );
4660
4661 m_selection->SetSelectionMode( selmode );
4662 }
4663
4664 wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes wxGrid::GetSelectionMode() const
4665 {
4666 wxCHECK_MSG( m_created, wxGridSelectCells,
4667 wxT("Called wxGrid::GetSelectionMode() before calling CreateGrid()") );
4668
4669 return m_selection->GetSelectionMode();
4670 }
4671
4672 bool
4673 wxGrid::SetTable(wxGridTableBase *table,
4674 bool takeOwnership,
4675 wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes selmode )
4676 {
4677 bool checkSelection = false;
4678 if ( m_created )
4679 {
4680 // stop all processing
4681 m_created = false;
4682
4683 if (m_table)
4684 {
4685 m_table->SetView(0);
4686 if( m_ownTable )
4687 delete m_table;
4688 m_table = NULL;
4689 }
4690
4691 delete m_selection;
4692 m_selection = NULL;
4693
4694 m_ownTable = false;
4695 m_numRows = 0;
4696 m_numCols = 0;
4697 checkSelection = true;
4698
4699 // kill row and column size arrays
4700 m_colWidths.Empty();
4701 m_colRights.Empty();
4702 m_rowHeights.Empty();
4703 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
4704 }
4705
4706 if (table)
4707 {
4708 m_numRows = table->GetNumberRows();
4709 m_numCols = table->GetNumberCols();
4710
4711 m_table = table;
4712 m_table->SetView( this );
4713 m_ownTable = takeOwnership;
4714 m_selection = new wxGridSelection( this, selmode );
4715 if (checkSelection)
4716 {
4717 // If the newly set table is smaller than the
4718 // original one current cell and selection regions
4719 // might be invalid,
4720 m_selectedBlockCorner = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4721 m_currentCellCoords =
4722 wxGridCellCoords(wxMin(m_numRows, m_currentCellCoords.GetRow()),
4723 wxMin(m_numCols, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol()));
4724 if (m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetRow() >= m_numRows ||
4725 m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetCol() >= m_numCols)
4726 {
4727 m_selectedBlockTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4728 m_selectedBlockBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4729 }
4730 else
4731 m_selectedBlockBottomRight =
4732 wxGridCellCoords(wxMin(m_numRows,
4733 m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetRow()),
4734 wxMin(m_numCols,
4735 m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetCol()));
4736 }
4737 CalcDimensions();
4738
4739 m_created = true;
4740 }
4741
4742 return m_created;
4743 }
4744
4745 void wxGrid::InitVars()
4746 {
4747 m_created = false;
4748
4749 m_cornerLabelWin = NULL;
4750 m_rowLabelWin = NULL;
4751 m_colLabelWin = NULL;
4752 m_gridWin = NULL;
4753
4754 m_table = NULL;
4755 m_ownTable = false;
4756
4757 m_selection = NULL;
4758 m_defaultCellAttr = NULL;
4759 m_typeRegistry = NULL;
4760 m_winCapture = NULL;
4761 }
4762
4763 void wxGrid::Init()
4764 {
4765 m_rowLabelWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_ROW_LABEL_WIDTH;
4766 m_colLabelHeight = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_LABEL_HEIGHT;
4767
4768 if ( m_rowLabelWin )
4769 {
4770 m_labelBackgroundColour = m_rowLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour();
4771 }
4772 else
4773 {
4774 m_labelBackgroundColour = *wxWHITE;
4775 }
4776
4777 m_labelTextColour = *wxBLACK;
4778
4779 // init attr cache
4780 m_attrCache.row = -1;
4781 m_attrCache.col = -1;
4782 m_attrCache.attr = NULL;
4783
4784 m_labelFont = GetFont();
4785 m_labelFont.SetWeight( wxBOLD );
4786
4787 m_rowLabelHorizAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4788 m_rowLabelVertAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4789
4790 m_colLabelHorizAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4791 m_colLabelVertAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4792 m_colLabelTextOrientation = wxHORIZONTAL;
4793
4794 m_defaultColWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_WIDTH;
4795 m_defaultRowHeight = m_gridWin->GetCharHeight();
4796
4797 m_minAcceptableColWidth = WXGRID_MIN_COL_WIDTH;
4798 m_minAcceptableRowHeight = WXGRID_MIN_ROW_HEIGHT;
4799
4800 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__) || defined(__WXGTK__) // see also text ctrl sizing in ShowCellEditControl()
4801 m_defaultRowHeight += 8;
4802 #else
4803 m_defaultRowHeight += 4;
4804 #endif
4805
4806 m_gridLineColour = wxColour( 192,192,192 );
4807 m_gridLinesEnabled = true;
4808 m_gridLinesClipHorz =
4809 m_gridLinesClipVert = true;
4810 m_cellHighlightColour = *wxBLACK;
4811 m_cellHighlightPenWidth = 2;
4812 m_cellHighlightROPenWidth = 1;
4813
4814 m_canDragColMove = false;
4815
4816 m_cursorMode = WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL;
4817 m_winCapture = NULL;
4818 m_canDragRowSize = true;
4819 m_canDragColSize = true;
4820 m_canDragGridSize = true;
4821 m_canDragCell = false;
4822 m_dragLastPos = -1;
4823 m_dragRowOrCol = -1;
4824 m_isDragging = false;
4825 m_startDragPos = wxDefaultPosition;
4826 m_nativeColumnLabels = false;
4827
4828 m_waitForSlowClick = false;
4829
4830 m_rowResizeCursor = wxCursor( wxCURSOR_SIZENS );
4831 m_colResizeCursor = wxCursor( wxCURSOR_SIZEWE );
4832
4833 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4834
4835 ClearSelection();
4836
4837 m_selectionBackground = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT);
4838 m_selectionForeground = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT);
4839
4840 m_editable = true; // default for whole grid
4841
4842 m_inOnKeyDown = false;
4843 m_batchCount = 0;
4844
4845 m_extraWidth =
4846 m_extraHeight = 0;
4847
4848 m_scrollLineX = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X;
4849 m_scrollLineY = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y;
4850 }
4851
4852 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
4853 // the idea is to call these functions only when necessary because they create
4854 // quite big arrays which eat memory mostly unnecessary - in particular, if
4855 // default widths/heights are used for all rows/columns, we may not use these
4856 // arrays at all
4857 //
4858 // with some extra code, it should be possible to only store the widths/heights
4859 // different from default ones (resulting in space savings for huge grids) but
4860 // this is not done currently
4861 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
4862
4863 void wxGrid::InitRowHeights()
4864 {
4865 m_rowHeights.Empty();
4866 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
4867
4868 m_rowHeights.Alloc( m_numRows );
4869 m_rowBottoms.Alloc( m_numRows );
4870
4871 m_rowHeights.Add( m_defaultRowHeight, m_numRows );
4872
4873 int rowBottom = 0;
4874 for ( int i = 0; i < m_numRows; i++ )
4875 {
4876 rowBottom += m_defaultRowHeight;
4877 m_rowBottoms.Add( rowBottom );
4878 }
4879 }
4880
4881 void wxGrid::InitColWidths()
4882 {
4883 m_colWidths.Empty();
4884 m_colRights.Empty();
4885
4886 m_colWidths.Alloc( m_numCols );
4887 m_colRights.Alloc( m_numCols );
4888
4889 m_colWidths.Add( m_defaultColWidth, m_numCols );
4890
4891 for ( int i = 0; i < m_numCols; i++ )
4892 {
4893 int colRight = ( GetColPos( i ) + 1 ) * m_defaultColWidth;
4894 m_colRights.Add( colRight );
4895 }
4896 }
4897
4898 int wxGrid::GetColWidth(int col) const
4899 {
4900 return m_colWidths.IsEmpty() ? m_defaultColWidth : m_colWidths[col];
4901 }
4902
4903 int wxGrid::GetColLeft(int col) const
4904 {
4905 return m_colRights.IsEmpty() ? GetColPos( col ) * m_defaultColWidth
4906 : m_colRights[col] - m_colWidths[col];
4907 }
4908
4909 int wxGrid::GetColRight(int col) const
4910 {
4911 return m_colRights.IsEmpty() ? (GetColPos( col ) + 1) * m_defaultColWidth
4912 : m_colRights[col];
4913 }
4914
4915 int wxGrid::GetRowHeight(int row) const
4916 {
4917 return m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() ? m_defaultRowHeight : m_rowHeights[row];
4918 }
4919
4920 int wxGrid::GetRowTop(int row) const
4921 {
4922 return m_rowBottoms.IsEmpty() ? row * m_defaultRowHeight
4923 : m_rowBottoms[row] - m_rowHeights[row];
4924 }
4925
4926 int wxGrid::GetRowBottom(int row) const
4927 {
4928 return m_rowBottoms.IsEmpty() ? (row + 1) * m_defaultRowHeight
4929 : m_rowBottoms[row];
4930 }
4931
4932 void wxGrid::CalcDimensions()
4933 {
4934 // compute the size of the scrollable area
4935 int w = m_numCols > 0 ? GetColRight(GetColAt(m_numCols - 1)) : 0;
4936 int h = m_numRows > 0 ? GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1) : 0;
4937
4938 w += m_extraWidth;
4939 h += m_extraHeight;
4940
4941 // take into account editor if shown
4942 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
4943 {
4944 int w2, h2;
4945 int r = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
4946 int c = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
4947 int x = GetColLeft(c);
4948 int y = GetRowTop(r);
4949
4950 // how big is the editor
4951 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(r, c);
4952 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, r, c);
4953 editor->GetControl()->GetSize(&w2, &h2);
4954 w2 += x;
4955 h2 += y;
4956 if ( w2 > w )
4957 w = w2;
4958 if ( h2 > h )
4959 h = h2;
4960 editor->DecRef();
4961 attr->DecRef();
4962 }
4963
4964 // preserve (more or less) the previous position
4965 int x, y;
4966 GetViewStart( &x, &y );
4967
4968 // ensure the position is valid for the new scroll ranges
4969 if ( x >= w )
4970 x = wxMax( w - 1, 0 );
4971 if ( y >= h )
4972 y = wxMax( h - 1, 0 );
4973
4974 // update the virtual size and refresh the scrollbars to reflect it
4975 m_gridWin->SetVirtualSize(w, h);
4976 Scroll(x, y);
4977 AdjustScrollbars();
4978
4979 // if our OnSize() hadn't been called (it would if we have scrollbars), we
4980 // still must reposition the children
4981 CalcWindowSizes();
4982 }
4983
4984 wxSize wxGrid::GetSizeAvailableForScrollTarget(const wxSize& size)
4985 {
4986 wxSize sizeGridWin(size);
4987 sizeGridWin.x -= m_rowLabelWidth;
4988 sizeGridWin.y -= m_colLabelHeight;
4989
4990 return sizeGridWin;
4991 }
4992
4993 void wxGrid::CalcWindowSizes()
4994 {
4995 // escape if the window is has not been fully created yet
4996
4997 if ( m_cornerLabelWin == NULL )
4998 return;
4999
5000 int cw, ch;
5001 GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5002
5003 // the grid may be too small to have enough space for the labels yet, don't
5004 // size the windows to negative sizes in this case
5005 int gw = cw - m_rowLabelWidth;
5006 int gh = ch - m_colLabelHeight;
5007 if (gw < 0)
5008 gw = 0;
5009 if (gh < 0)
5010 gh = 0;
5011
5012 if ( m_cornerLabelWin && m_cornerLabelWin->IsShown() )
5013 m_cornerLabelWin->SetSize( 0, 0, m_rowLabelWidth, m_colLabelHeight );
5014
5015 if ( m_colLabelWin && m_colLabelWin->IsShown() )
5016 m_colLabelWin->SetSize( m_rowLabelWidth, 0, gw, m_colLabelHeight );
5017
5018 if ( m_rowLabelWin && m_rowLabelWin->IsShown() )
5019 m_rowLabelWin->SetSize( 0, m_colLabelHeight, m_rowLabelWidth, gh );
5020
5021 if ( m_gridWin && m_gridWin->IsShown() )
5022 m_gridWin->SetSize( m_rowLabelWidth, m_colLabelHeight, gw, gh );
5023 }
5024
5025 // this is called when the grid table sends a message
5026 // to indicate that it has been redimensioned
5027 //
5028 bool wxGrid::Redimension( wxGridTableMessage& msg )
5029 {
5030 int i;
5031 bool result = false;
5032
5033 // Clear the attribute cache as the attribute might refer to a different
5034 // cell than stored in the cache after adding/removing rows/columns.
5035 ClearAttrCache();
5036
5037 // By the same reasoning, the editor should be dismissed if columns are
5038 // added or removed. And for consistency, it should IMHO always be
5039 // removed, not only if the cell "underneath" it actually changes.
5040 // For now, I intentionally do not save the editor's content as the
5041 // cell it might want to save that stuff to might no longer exist.
5042 HideCellEditControl();
5043
5044 #if 0
5045 // if we were using the default widths/heights so far, we must change them
5046 // now
5047 if ( m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5048 {
5049 InitColWidths();
5050 }
5051
5052 if ( m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
5053 {
5054 InitRowHeights();
5055 }
5056 #endif
5057
5058 switch ( msg.GetId() )
5059 {
5060 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED:
5061 {
5062 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
5063 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt2();
5064
5065 m_numRows += numRows;
5066
5067 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
5068 {
5069 m_rowHeights.Insert( m_defaultRowHeight, pos, numRows );
5070 m_rowBottoms.Insert( 0, pos, numRows );
5071
5072 int bottom = 0;
5073 if ( pos > 0 )
5074 bottom = m_rowBottoms[pos - 1];
5075
5076 for ( i = pos; i < m_numRows; i++ )
5077 {
5078 bottom += m_rowHeights[i];
5079 m_rowBottoms[i] = bottom;
5080 }
5081 }
5082
5083 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
5084 {
5085 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
5086 // cell will be undefined...
5087 //
5088 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
5089 }
5090
5091 if ( m_selection )
5092 m_selection->UpdateRows( pos, numRows );
5093 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
5094 if (attrProvider)
5095 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( pos, numRows );
5096
5097 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5098 {
5099 CalcDimensions();
5100 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
5101 }
5102 }
5103 result = true;
5104 break;
5105
5106 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED:
5107 {
5108 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt();
5109 int oldNumRows = m_numRows;
5110 m_numRows += numRows;
5111
5112 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
5113 {
5114 m_rowHeights.Add( m_defaultRowHeight, numRows );
5115 m_rowBottoms.Add( 0, numRows );
5116
5117 int bottom = 0;
5118 if ( oldNumRows > 0 )
5119 bottom = m_rowBottoms[oldNumRows - 1];
5120
5121 for ( i = oldNumRows; i < m_numRows; i++ )
5122 {
5123 bottom += m_rowHeights[i];
5124 m_rowBottoms[i] = bottom;
5125 }
5126 }
5127
5128 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
5129 {
5130 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
5131 // cell will be undefined...
5132 //
5133 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
5134 }
5135
5136 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5137 {
5138 CalcDimensions();
5139 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
5140 }
5141 }
5142 result = true;
5143 break;
5144
5145 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED:
5146 {
5147 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
5148 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt2();
5149 m_numRows -= numRows;
5150
5151 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
5152 {
5153 m_rowHeights.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
5154 m_rowBottoms.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
5155
5156 int h = 0;
5157 for ( i = 0; i < m_numRows; i++ )
5158 {
5159 h += m_rowHeights[i];
5160 m_rowBottoms[i] = h;
5161 }
5162 }
5163
5164 if ( !m_numRows )
5165 {
5166 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
5167 }
5168 else
5169 {
5170 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() >= m_numRows )
5171 m_currentCellCoords.Set( 0, 0 );
5172 }
5173
5174 if ( m_selection )
5175 m_selection->UpdateRows( pos, -((int)numRows) );
5176 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
5177 if (attrProvider)
5178 {
5179 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( pos, -((int)numRows) );
5180
5181 // ifdef'd out following patch from Paul Gammans
5182 #if 0
5183 // No need to touch column attributes, unless we
5184 // removed _all_ rows, in this case, we remove
5185 // all column attributes.
5186 // I hate to do this here, but the
5187 // needed data is not available inside UpdateAttrRows.
5188 if ( !GetNumberRows() )
5189 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( 0, -GetNumberCols() );
5190 #endif
5191 }
5192
5193 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5194 {
5195 CalcDimensions();
5196 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
5197 }
5198 }
5199 result = true;
5200 break;
5201
5202 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED:
5203 {
5204 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
5205 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt2();
5206 m_numCols += numCols;
5207
5208 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
5209 {
5210 //Shift the column IDs
5211 int i;
5212 for ( i = 0; i < m_numCols - numCols; i++ )
5213 {
5214 if ( m_colAt[i] >= (int)pos )
5215 m_colAt[i] += numCols;
5216 }
5217
5218 m_colAt.Insert( pos, pos, numCols );
5219
5220 //Set the new columns' positions
5221 for ( i = pos + 1; i < (int)pos + numCols; i++ )
5222 {
5223 m_colAt[i] = i;
5224 }
5225 }
5226
5227 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5228 {
5229 m_colWidths.Insert( m_defaultColWidth, pos, numCols );
5230 m_colRights.Insert( 0, pos, numCols );
5231
5232 int right = 0;
5233 if ( pos > 0 )
5234 right = m_colRights[GetColAt( pos - 1 )];
5235
5236 int colPos;
5237 for ( colPos = pos; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5238 {
5239 i = GetColAt( colPos );
5240
5241 right += m_colWidths[i];
5242 m_colRights[i] = right;
5243 }
5244 }
5245
5246 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
5247 {
5248 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
5249 // cell will be undefined...
5250 //
5251 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
5252 }
5253
5254 if ( m_selection )
5255 m_selection->UpdateCols( pos, numCols );
5256 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
5257 if (attrProvider)
5258 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( pos, numCols );
5259 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5260 {
5261 CalcDimensions();
5262 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
5263 }
5264 }
5265 result = true;
5266 break;
5267
5268 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED:
5269 {
5270 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt();
5271 int oldNumCols = m_numCols;
5272 m_numCols += numCols;
5273
5274 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
5275 {
5276 m_colAt.Add( 0, numCols );
5277
5278 //Set the new columns' positions
5279 int i;
5280 for ( i = oldNumCols; i < m_numCols; i++ )
5281 {
5282 m_colAt[i] = i;
5283 }
5284 }
5285
5286 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5287 {
5288 m_colWidths.Add( m_defaultColWidth, numCols );
5289 m_colRights.Add( 0, numCols );
5290
5291 int right = 0;
5292 if ( oldNumCols > 0 )
5293 right = m_colRights[GetColAt( oldNumCols - 1 )];
5294
5295 int colPos;
5296 for ( colPos = oldNumCols; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5297 {
5298 i = GetColAt( colPos );
5299
5300 right += m_colWidths[i];
5301 m_colRights[i] = right;
5302 }
5303 }
5304
5305 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
5306 {
5307 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
5308 // cell will be undefined...
5309 //
5310 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
5311 }
5312 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5313 {
5314 CalcDimensions();
5315 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
5316 }
5317 }
5318 result = true;
5319 break;
5320
5321 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED:
5322 {
5323 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
5324 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt2();
5325 m_numCols -= numCols;
5326
5327 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
5328 {
5329 int colID = GetColAt( pos );
5330
5331 m_colAt.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5332
5333 //Shift the column IDs
5334 int colPos;
5335 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5336 {
5337 if ( m_colAt[colPos] > colID )
5338 m_colAt[colPos] -= numCols;
5339 }
5340 }
5341
5342 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5343 {
5344 m_colWidths.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5345 m_colRights.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5346
5347 int w = 0;
5348 int colPos;
5349 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5350 {
5351 i = GetColAt( colPos );
5352
5353 w += m_colWidths[i];
5354 m_colRights[i] = w;
5355 }
5356 }
5357
5358 if ( !m_numCols )
5359 {
5360 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
5361 }
5362 else
5363 {
5364 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() >= m_numCols )
5365 m_currentCellCoords.Set( 0, 0 );
5366 }
5367
5368 if ( m_selection )
5369 m_selection->UpdateCols( pos, -((int)numCols) );
5370 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
5371 if (attrProvider)
5372 {
5373 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( pos, -((int)numCols) );
5374
5375 // ifdef'd out following patch from Paul Gammans
5376 #if 0
5377 // No need to touch row attributes, unless we
5378 // removed _all_ columns, in this case, we remove
5379 // all row attributes.
5380 // I hate to do this here, but the
5381 // needed data is not available inside UpdateAttrCols.
5382 if ( !GetNumberCols() )
5383 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( 0, -GetNumberRows() );
5384 #endif
5385 }
5386
5387 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5388 {
5389 CalcDimensions();
5390 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
5391 }
5392 }
5393 result = true;
5394 break;
5395 }
5396
5397 if (result && !GetBatchCount() )
5398 m_gridWin->Refresh();
5399
5400 return result;
5401 }
5402
5403 wxArrayInt wxGrid::CalcRowLabelsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5404 {
5405 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5406 wxRect r;
5407
5408 wxArrayInt rowlabels;
5409
5410 int top, bottom;
5411 while ( iter )
5412 {
5413 r = iter.GetRect();
5414
5415 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5416 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5417 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5418 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5419 //
5420 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5421 int cw, ch;
5422 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5423 if ( r.GetTop() > ch )
5424 r.SetTop( 0 );
5425 r.SetBottom( wxMin( r.GetBottom(), ch ) );
5426 #endif
5427
5428 // logical bounds of update region
5429 //
5430 int dummy;
5431 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, r.GetTop(), &dummy, &top );
5432 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, r.GetBottom(), &dummy, &bottom );
5433
5434 // find the row labels within these bounds
5435 //
5436 int row;
5437 for ( row = internalYToRow(top); row < m_numRows; row++ )
5438 {
5439 if ( GetRowBottom(row) < top )
5440 continue;
5441
5442 if ( GetRowTop(row) > bottom )
5443 break;
5444
5445 rowlabels.Add( row );
5446 }
5447
5448 ++iter;
5449 }
5450
5451 return rowlabels;
5452 }
5453
5454 wxArrayInt wxGrid::CalcColLabelsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5455 {
5456 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5457 wxRect r;
5458
5459 wxArrayInt colLabels;
5460
5461 int left, right;
5462 while ( iter )
5463 {
5464 r = iter.GetRect();
5465
5466 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5467 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5468 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5469 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5470 //
5471 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5472 int cw, ch;
5473 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5474 if ( r.GetLeft() > cw )
5475 r.SetLeft( 0 );
5476 r.SetRight( wxMin( r.GetRight(), cw ) );
5477 #endif
5478
5479 // logical bounds of update region
5480 //
5481 int dummy;
5482 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), 0, &left, &dummy );
5483 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), 0, &right, &dummy );
5484
5485 // find the cells within these bounds
5486 //
5487 int col;
5488 int colPos;
5489 for ( colPos = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) ); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5490 {
5491 col = GetColAt( colPos );
5492
5493 if ( GetColRight(col) < left )
5494 continue;
5495
5496 if ( GetColLeft(col) > right )
5497 break;
5498
5499 colLabels.Add( col );
5500 }
5501
5502 ++iter;
5503 }
5504
5505 return colLabels;
5506 }
5507
5508 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::CalcCellsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5509 {
5510 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5511 wxRect r;
5512
5513 wxGridCellCoordsArray cellsExposed;
5514
5515 int left, top, right, bottom;
5516 while ( iter )
5517 {
5518 r = iter.GetRect();
5519
5520 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5521 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5522 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5523 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5524 //
5525 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5526 int cw, ch;
5527 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5528 if ( r.GetTop() > ch ) r.SetTop( 0 );
5529 if ( r.GetLeft() > cw ) r.SetLeft( 0 );
5530 r.SetRight( wxMin( r.GetRight(), cw ) );
5531 r.SetBottom( wxMin( r.GetBottom(), ch ) );
5532 #endif
5533
5534 // logical bounds of update region
5535 //
5536 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
5537 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
5538
5539 // find the cells within these bounds
5540 //
5541 int row, col;
5542 for ( row = internalYToRow(top); row < m_numRows; row++ )
5543 {
5544 if ( GetRowBottom(row) <= top )
5545 continue;
5546
5547 if ( GetRowTop(row) > bottom )
5548 break;
5549
5550 int colPos;
5551 for ( colPos = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) ); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5552 {
5553 col = GetColAt( colPos );
5554
5555 if ( GetColRight(col) <= left )
5556 continue;
5557
5558 if ( GetColLeft(col) > right )
5559 break;
5560
5561 cellsExposed.Add( wxGridCellCoords( row, col ) );
5562 }
5563 }
5564
5565 ++iter;
5566 }
5567
5568 return cellsExposed;
5569 }
5570
5571
5572 void wxGrid::ProcessRowLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5573 {
5574 int x, y, row;
5575 wxPoint pos( event.GetPosition() );
5576 CalcUnscrolledPosition( pos.x, pos.y, &x, &y );
5577
5578 if ( event.Dragging() )
5579 {
5580 if (!m_isDragging)
5581 {
5582 m_isDragging = true;
5583 m_rowLabelWin->CaptureMouse();
5584 }
5585
5586 if ( event.LeftIsDown() )
5587 {
5588 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5589 {
5590 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
5591 {
5592 int cw, ch, left, dummy;
5593 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5594 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &dummy );
5595
5596 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
5597 PrepareDC( dc );
5598 y = wxMax( y,
5599 GetRowTop(m_dragRowOrCol) +
5600 GetRowMinimalHeight(m_dragRowOrCol) );
5601 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
5602 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5603 {
5604 dc.DrawLine( left, m_dragLastPos, left+cw, m_dragLastPos );
5605 }
5606 dc.DrawLine( left, y, left+cw, y );
5607 m_dragLastPos = y;
5608 }
5609 break;
5610
5611 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW:
5612 {
5613 if ( (row = YToRow( y )) >= 0 )
5614 {
5615 if ( m_selection )
5616 m_selection->SelectRow(row, event);
5617 }
5618 }
5619 break;
5620
5621 // default label to suppress warnings about "enumeration value
5622 // 'xxx' not handled in switch
5623 default:
5624 break;
5625 }
5626 }
5627 return;
5628 }
5629
5630 if ( m_isDragging && (event.Entering() || event.Leaving()) )
5631 return;
5632
5633 if (m_isDragging)
5634 {
5635 if (m_rowLabelWin->HasCapture())
5636 m_rowLabelWin->ReleaseMouse();
5637 m_isDragging = false;
5638 }
5639
5640 // ------------ Entering or leaving the window
5641 //
5642 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
5643 {
5644 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin);
5645 }
5646
5647 // ------------ Left button pressed
5648 //
5649 else if ( event.LeftDown() )
5650 {
5651 // don't send a label click event for a hit on the
5652 // edge of the row label - this is probably the user
5653 // wanting to resize the row
5654 //
5655 if ( YToEdgeOfRow(y) < 0 )
5656 {
5657 row = YToRow(y);
5658 if ( row >= 0 &&
5659 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5660 {
5661 if ( !event.ShiftDown() && !event.CmdDown() )
5662 ClearSelection();
5663 if ( m_selection )
5664 {
5665 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
5666 {
5667 m_selection->SelectBlock
5668 (
5669 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow(), 0,
5670 row, GetNumberCols() - 1,
5671 event
5672 );
5673 }
5674 else
5675 {
5676 m_selection->SelectRow(row, event);
5677 }
5678 }
5679
5680 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW, m_rowLabelWin);
5681 }
5682 }
5683 else
5684 {
5685 // starting to drag-resize a row
5686 if ( CanDragRowSize() )
5687 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, m_rowLabelWin);
5688 }
5689 }
5690
5691 // ------------ Left double click
5692 //
5693 else if (event.LeftDClick() )
5694 {
5695 row = YToEdgeOfRow(y);
5696 if ( row < 0 )
5697 {
5698 row = YToRow(y);
5699 if ( row >=0 &&
5700 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5701 {
5702 // no default action at the moment
5703 }
5704 }
5705 else
5706 {
5707 // adjust row height depending on label text
5708 AutoSizeRowLabelSize( row );
5709
5710 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5711 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 // ------------ Left button released
5716 //
5717 else if ( event.LeftUp() )
5718 {
5719 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW )
5720 {
5721 DoEndDragResizeRow();
5722
5723 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
5724 // default processing in this case
5725 //
5726 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE, m_dragRowOrCol, -1, event );
5727 }
5728
5729 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin);
5730 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5731 }
5732
5733 // ------------ Right button down
5734 //
5735 else if ( event.RightDown() )
5736 {
5737 row = YToRow(y);
5738 if ( row >=0 &&
5739 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5740 {
5741 // no default action at the moment
5742 }
5743 }
5744
5745 // ------------ Right double click
5746 //
5747 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
5748 {
5749 row = YToRow(y);
5750 if ( row >= 0 &&
5751 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5752 {
5753 // no default action at the moment
5754 }
5755 }
5756
5757 // ------------ No buttons down and mouse moving
5758 //
5759 else if ( event.Moving() )
5760 {
5761 m_dragRowOrCol = YToEdgeOfRow( y );
5762 if ( m_dragRowOrCol >= 0 )
5763 {
5764 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5765 {
5766 // don't capture the mouse yet
5767 if ( CanDragRowSize() )
5768 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, m_rowLabelWin, false);
5769 }
5770 }
5771 else if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5772 {
5773 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin, false);
5774 }
5775 }
5776 }
5777
5778 void wxGrid::ProcessColLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5779 {
5780 int x, y, col;
5781 wxPoint pos( event.GetPosition() );
5782 CalcUnscrolledPosition( pos.x, pos.y, &x, &y );
5783
5784 if ( event.Dragging() )
5785 {
5786 if (!m_isDragging)
5787 {
5788 m_isDragging = true;
5789 m_colLabelWin->CaptureMouse();
5790
5791 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL )
5792 m_dragRowOrCol = XToCol( x );
5793 }
5794
5795 if ( event.LeftIsDown() )
5796 {
5797 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5798 {
5799 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
5800 {
5801 int cw, ch, dummy, top;
5802 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5803 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &dummy, &top );
5804
5805 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
5806 PrepareDC( dc );
5807
5808 x = wxMax( x, GetColLeft(m_dragRowOrCol) +
5809 GetColMinimalWidth(m_dragRowOrCol));
5810 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
5811 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5812 {
5813 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos, top, m_dragLastPos, top + ch );
5814 }
5815 dc.DrawLine( x, top, x, top + ch );
5816 m_dragLastPos = x;
5817 }
5818 break;
5819
5820 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL:
5821 {
5822 if ( (col = XToCol( x )) >= 0 )
5823 {
5824 if ( m_selection )
5825 m_selection->SelectCol(col, event);
5826 }
5827 }
5828 break;
5829
5830 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
5831 {
5832 if ( x < 0 )
5833 m_moveToCol = GetColAt( 0 );
5834 else
5835 m_moveToCol = XToCol( x );
5836
5837 int markerX;
5838
5839 if ( m_moveToCol < 0 )
5840 markerX = GetColRight( GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 ) );
5841 else if ( x >= (GetColLeft( m_moveToCol ) + (GetColWidth(m_moveToCol) / 2)) )
5842 {
5843 m_moveToCol = GetColAt( GetColPos( m_moveToCol ) + 1 );
5844 if ( m_moveToCol < 0 )
5845 markerX = GetColRight( GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 ) );
5846 else
5847 markerX = GetColLeft( m_moveToCol );
5848 }
5849 else
5850 markerX = GetColLeft( m_moveToCol );
5851
5852 if ( markerX != m_dragLastPos )
5853 {
5854 wxClientDC dc( m_colLabelWin );
5855 DoPrepareDC(dc);
5856
5857 int cw, ch;
5858 m_colLabelWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5859
5860 markerX++;
5861
5862 //Clean up the last indicator
5863 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5864 {
5865 wxPen pen( m_colLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour(), 2 );
5866 dc.SetPen(pen);
5867 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos + 1, 0, m_dragLastPos + 1, ch );
5868 dc.SetPen(wxNullPen);
5869
5870 if ( XToCol( m_dragLastPos ) != -1 )
5871 DrawColLabel( dc, XToCol( m_dragLastPos ) );
5872 }
5873
5874 const wxColour *color;
5875 //Moving to the same place? Don't draw a marker
5876 if ( (m_moveToCol == m_dragRowOrCol)
5877 || (GetColPos( m_moveToCol ) == GetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol ) + 1)
5878 || (m_moveToCol < 0 && m_dragRowOrCol == GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 )))
5879 color = wxLIGHT_GREY;
5880 else
5881 color = wxBLUE;
5882
5883 //Draw the marker
5884 wxPen pen( *color, 2 );
5885 dc.SetPen(pen);
5886
5887 dc.DrawLine( markerX, 0, markerX, ch );
5888
5889 dc.SetPen(wxNullPen);
5890
5891 m_dragLastPos = markerX - 1;
5892 }
5893 }
5894 break;
5895
5896 // default label to suppress warnings about "enumeration value
5897 // 'xxx' not handled in switch
5898 default:
5899 break;
5900 }
5901 }
5902 return;
5903 }
5904
5905 if ( m_isDragging && (event.Entering() || event.Leaving()) )
5906 return;
5907
5908 if (m_isDragging)
5909 {
5910 if (m_colLabelWin->HasCapture())
5911 m_colLabelWin->ReleaseMouse();
5912 m_isDragging = false;
5913 }
5914
5915 // ------------ Entering or leaving the window
5916 //
5917 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
5918 {
5919 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5920 }
5921
5922 // ------------ Left button pressed
5923 //
5924 else if ( event.LeftDown() )
5925 {
5926 // don't send a label click event for a hit on the
5927 // edge of the col label - this is probably the user
5928 // wanting to resize the col
5929 //
5930 if ( XToEdgeOfCol(x) < 0 )
5931 {
5932 col = XToCol(x);
5933 if ( col >= 0 &&
5934 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5935 {
5936 if ( m_canDragColMove )
5937 {
5938 //Show button as pressed
5939 wxClientDC dc( m_colLabelWin );
5940 int colLeft = GetColLeft( col );
5941 int colRight = GetColRight( col ) - 1;
5942 dc.SetPen( wxPen( m_colLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour(), 1 ) );
5943 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colLeft, m_colLabelHeight-1 );
5944 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colRight, 1 );
5945
5946 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5947 }
5948 else
5949 {
5950 if ( !event.ShiftDown() && !event.CmdDown() )
5951 ClearSelection();
5952 if ( m_selection )
5953 {
5954 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
5955 {
5956 m_selection->SelectBlock
5957 (
5958 0, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol(),
5959 GetNumberRows() - 1, col,
5960 event
5961 );
5962 }
5963 else
5964 {
5965 m_selection->SelectCol(col, event);
5966 }
5967 }
5968
5969 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5970 }
5971 }
5972 }
5973 else
5974 {
5975 // starting to drag-resize a col
5976 //
5977 if ( CanDragColSize() )
5978 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5979 }
5980 }
5981
5982 // ------------ Left double click
5983 //
5984 if ( event.LeftDClick() )
5985 {
5986 col = XToEdgeOfCol(x);
5987 if ( col < 0 )
5988 {
5989 col = XToCol(x);
5990 if ( col >= 0 &&
5991 ! SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5992 {
5993 // no default action at the moment
5994 }
5995 }
5996 else
5997 {
5998 // adjust column width depending on label text
5999 AutoSizeColLabelSize( col );
6000
6001 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
6002 m_dragLastPos = -1;
6003 }
6004 }
6005
6006 // ------------ Left button released
6007 //
6008 else if ( event.LeftUp() )
6009 {
6010 switch ( m_cursorMode )
6011 {
6012 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
6013 DoEndDragResizeCol();
6014
6015 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
6016 // default processing in this case
6017 //
6018 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
6019 break;
6020
6021 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
6022 DoEndDragMoveCol();
6023
6024 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_MOVE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
6025 break;
6026
6027 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL:
6028 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL:
6029 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
6030 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW:
6031 // nothing to do (?)
6032 break;
6033 }
6034
6035 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
6036 m_dragLastPos = -1;
6037 }
6038
6039 // ------------ Right button down
6040 //
6041 else if ( event.RightDown() )
6042 {
6043 col = XToCol(x);
6044 if ( col >= 0 &&
6045 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, -1, col, event ) )
6046 {
6047 // no default action at the moment
6048 }
6049 }
6050
6051 // ------------ Right double click
6052 //
6053 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
6054 {
6055 col = XToCol(x);
6056 if ( col >= 0 &&
6057 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, -1, col, event ) )
6058 {
6059 // no default action at the moment
6060 }
6061 }
6062
6063 // ------------ No buttons down and mouse moving
6064 //
6065 else if ( event.Moving() )
6066 {
6067 m_dragRowOrCol = XToEdgeOfCol( x );
6068 if ( m_dragRowOrCol >= 0 )
6069 {
6070 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6071 {
6072 // don't capture the cursor yet
6073 if ( CanDragColSize() )
6074 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, m_colLabelWin, false);
6075 }
6076 }
6077 else if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6078 {
6079 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin, false);
6080 }
6081 }
6082 }
6083
6084 void wxGrid::ProcessCornerLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
6085 {
6086 if ( event.LeftDown() )
6087 {
6088 // indicate corner label by having both row and
6089 // col args == -1
6090 //
6091 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
6092 {
6093 SelectAll();
6094 }
6095 }
6096 else if ( event.LeftDClick() )
6097 {
6098 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, -1, -1, event );
6099 }
6100 else if ( event.RightDown() )
6101 {
6102 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
6103 {
6104 // no default action at the moment
6105 }
6106 }
6107 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
6108 {
6109 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
6110 {
6111 // no default action at the moment
6112 }
6113 }
6114 }
6115
6116 void wxGrid::CancelMouseCapture()
6117 {
6118 // cancel operation currently in progress, whatever it is
6119 if ( m_winCapture )
6120 {
6121 m_isDragging = false;
6122 m_startDragPos = wxDefaultPosition;
6123
6124 m_cursorMode = WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL;
6125 m_winCapture->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
6126 m_winCapture = NULL;
6127
6128 // remove traces of whatever we drew on screen
6129 Refresh();
6130 }
6131 }
6132
6133 void wxGrid::ChangeCursorMode(CursorMode mode,
6134 wxWindow *win,
6135 bool captureMouse)
6136 {
6137 #ifdef __WXDEBUG__
6138 static const wxChar *cursorModes[] =
6139 {
6140 _T("SELECT_CELL"),
6141 _T("RESIZE_ROW"),
6142 _T("RESIZE_COL"),
6143 _T("SELECT_ROW"),
6144 _T("SELECT_COL"),
6145 _T("MOVE_COL"),
6146 };
6147
6148 wxLogTrace(_T("grid"),
6149 _T("wxGrid cursor mode (mouse capture for %s): %s -> %s"),
6150 win == m_colLabelWin ? _T("colLabelWin")
6151 : win ? _T("rowLabelWin")
6152 : _T("gridWin"),
6153 cursorModes[m_cursorMode], cursorModes[mode]);
6154 #endif
6155
6156 if ( mode == m_cursorMode &&
6157 win == m_winCapture &&
6158 captureMouse == (m_winCapture != NULL))
6159 return;
6160
6161 if ( !win )
6162 {
6163 // by default use the grid itself
6164 win = m_gridWin;
6165 }
6166
6167 if ( m_winCapture )
6168 {
6169 m_winCapture->ReleaseMouse();
6170 m_winCapture = NULL;
6171 }
6172
6173 m_cursorMode = mode;
6174
6175 switch ( m_cursorMode )
6176 {
6177 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
6178 win->SetCursor( m_rowResizeCursor );
6179 break;
6180
6181 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
6182 win->SetCursor( m_colResizeCursor );
6183 break;
6184
6185 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
6186 win->SetCursor( wxCursor(wxCURSOR_HAND) );
6187 break;
6188
6189 default:
6190 win->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
6191 break;
6192 }
6193
6194 // we need to capture mouse when resizing
6195 bool resize = m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW ||
6196 m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL;
6197
6198 if ( captureMouse && resize )
6199 {
6200 win->CaptureMouse();
6201 m_winCapture = win;
6202 }
6203 }
6204
6205 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
6206 // grid mouse event processing
6207 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
6208
6209 void
6210 wxGrid::DoGridCellDrag(wxMouseEvent& event,
6211 const wxGridCellCoords& coords,
6212 bool isFirstDrag)
6213 {
6214 if ( coords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
6215 return; // we're outside any valid cell
6216
6217 // Hide the edit control, so it won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
6218 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
6219 {
6220 HideCellEditControl();
6221 SaveEditControlValue();
6222 }
6223
6224 switch ( event.GetModifiers() )
6225 {
6226 case wxMOD_CMD:
6227 if ( m_selectedBlockCorner == wxGridNoCellCoords)
6228 m_selectedBlockCorner = coords;
6229 UpdateBlockBeingSelected(m_selectedBlockCorner, coords);
6230 break;
6231
6232 case wxMOD_NONE:
6233 if ( CanDragCell() )
6234 {
6235 if ( isFirstDrag )
6236 {
6237 if ( m_selectedBlockCorner == wxGridNoCellCoords)
6238 m_selectedBlockCorner = coords;
6239
6240 SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_BEGIN_DRAG, coords, event);
6241 return;
6242 }
6243 }
6244
6245 UpdateBlockBeingSelected(m_currentCellCoords, coords);
6246 break;
6247
6248 default:
6249 // we don't handle the other key modifiers
6250 event.Skip();
6251 }
6252 }
6253
6254 void wxGrid::DoGridLineDrag(wxMouseEvent& event, const wxGridOperations& oper)
6255 {
6256 wxClientDC dc(m_gridWin);
6257 PrepareDC(dc);
6258 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
6259
6260 const wxRect rectWin(CalcUnscrolledPosition(wxPoint(0, 0)),
6261 m_gridWin->GetClientSize());
6262
6263 // erase the previously drawn line, if any
6264 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
6265 oper.DrawParallelLineInRect(dc, rectWin, m_dragLastPos);
6266
6267 // we need the vertical position for rows and horizontal for columns here
6268 m_dragLastPos = oper.Dual().Select(CalcUnscrolledPosition(event.GetPosition()));
6269
6270 // don't allow resizing beneath the minimal size
6271 const int posMin = oper.GetLineStartPos(this, m_dragRowOrCol) +
6272 oper.GetMinimalLineSize(this, m_dragRowOrCol);
6273 if ( m_dragLastPos < posMin )
6274 m_dragLastPos = posMin;
6275
6276 // and draw it at the new position
6277 oper.DrawParallelLineInRect(dc, rectWin, m_dragLastPos);
6278 }
6279
6280 void wxGrid::DoGridDragEvent(wxMouseEvent& event, const wxGridCellCoords& coords)
6281 {
6282 if ( !m_isDragging )
6283 {
6284 // Don't start doing anything until the mouse has been dragged far
6285 // enough
6286 const wxPoint& pt = event.GetPosition();
6287 if ( m_startDragPos == wxDefaultPosition )
6288 {
6289 m_startDragPos = pt;
6290 return;
6291 }
6292
6293 if ( abs(m_startDragPos.x - pt.x) <= DRAG_SENSITIVITY &&
6294 abs(m_startDragPos.y - pt.y) <= DRAG_SENSITIVITY )
6295 return;
6296 }
6297
6298 const bool isFirstDrag = !m_isDragging;
6299 m_isDragging = true;
6300
6301 switch ( m_cursorMode )
6302 {
6303 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL:
6304 DoGridCellDrag(event, coords, isFirstDrag);
6305 break;
6306
6307 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
6308 DoGridLineDrag(event, wxGridRowOperations());
6309 break;
6310
6311 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
6312 DoGridLineDrag(event, wxGridColumnOperations());
6313 break;
6314
6315 default:
6316 event.Skip();
6317 }
6318
6319 if ( isFirstDrag )
6320 {
6321 m_winCapture = m_gridWin;
6322 m_winCapture->CaptureMouse();
6323 }
6324 }
6325
6326 void
6327 wxGrid::DoGridCellLeftDown(wxMouseEvent& event,
6328 const wxGridCellCoords& coords,
6329 const wxPoint& pos)
6330 {
6331 if ( SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_CLICK, coords, event) )
6332 {
6333 // event handled by user code, no need to do anything here
6334 return;
6335 }
6336
6337 if ( !event.CmdDown() )
6338 ClearSelection();
6339
6340 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
6341 {
6342 if ( m_selection )
6343 {
6344 m_selection->SelectBlock(m_currentCellCoords, coords, event);
6345 m_selectedBlockCorner = coords;
6346 }
6347 }
6348 else if ( XToEdgeOfCol(pos.x) < 0 && YToEdgeOfRow(pos.y) < 0 )
6349 {
6350 DisableCellEditControl();
6351 MakeCellVisible( coords );
6352
6353 if ( event.CmdDown() )
6354 {
6355 if ( m_selection )
6356 {
6357 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(coords, event);
6358 }
6359
6360 m_selectedBlockTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6361 m_selectedBlockBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6362 m_selectedBlockCorner = coords;
6363 }
6364 else
6365 {
6366 m_waitForSlowClick = m_currentCellCoords == coords &&
6367 coords != wxGridNoCellCoords;
6368 SetCurrentCell( coords );
6369 }
6370 }
6371 }
6372
6373 void
6374 wxGrid::DoGridCellLeftDClick(wxMouseEvent& event,
6375 const wxGridCellCoords& coords,
6376 const wxPoint& pos)
6377 {
6378 if ( XToEdgeOfCol(pos.x) < 0 && YToEdgeOfRow(pos.y) < 0 )
6379 {
6380 if ( !SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_DCLICK, coords, event) )
6381 {
6382 // we want double click to select a cell and start editing
6383 // (i.e. to behave in same way as sequence of two slow clicks):
6384 m_waitForSlowClick = true;
6385 }
6386 }
6387 }
6388
6389 void
6390 wxGrid::DoGridCellLeftUp(wxMouseEvent& event, const wxGridCellCoords& coords)
6391 {
6392 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6393 {
6394 if (m_winCapture)
6395 {
6396 m_winCapture->ReleaseMouse();
6397 m_winCapture = NULL;
6398 }
6399
6400 if ( coords == m_currentCellCoords && m_waitForSlowClick && CanEnableCellControl() )
6401 {
6402 ClearSelection();
6403 EnableCellEditControl();
6404
6405 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(coords);
6406 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol());
6407 editor->StartingClick();
6408 editor->DecRef();
6409 attr->DecRef();
6410
6411 m_waitForSlowClick = false;
6412 }
6413 else if ( m_selectedBlockTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
6414 m_selectedBlockBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6415 {
6416 if ( m_selection )
6417 {
6418 m_selection->SelectBlock( m_selectedBlockTopLeft,
6419 m_selectedBlockBottomRight,
6420 event );
6421 }
6422
6423 m_selectedBlockTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6424 m_selectedBlockBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6425
6426 // Show the edit control, if it has been hidden for
6427 // drag-shrinking.
6428 ShowCellEditControl();
6429 }
6430 }
6431 else if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW )
6432 {
6433 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6434 DoEndDragResizeRow();
6435
6436 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
6437 // default processing in this case
6438 //
6439 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE, m_dragRowOrCol, -1, event );
6440 }
6441 else if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL )
6442 {
6443 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6444 DoEndDragResizeCol();
6445
6446 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
6447 // default processing in this case
6448 //
6449 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
6450 }
6451
6452 m_dragLastPos = -1;
6453 }
6454
6455 void
6456 wxGrid::DoGridMouseMoveEvent(wxMouseEvent& WXUNUSED(event),
6457 const wxGridCellCoords& coords,
6458 const wxPoint& pos)
6459 {
6460 if ( coords.GetRow() < 0 || coords.GetCol() < 0 )
6461 {
6462 // out of grid cell area
6463 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6464 return;
6465 }
6466
6467 int dragRow = YToEdgeOfRow( pos.y );
6468 int dragCol = XToEdgeOfCol( pos.x );
6469
6470 // Dragging on the corner of a cell to resize in both
6471 // directions is not implemented yet...
6472 //
6473 if ( dragRow >= 0 && dragCol >= 0 )
6474 {
6475 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6476 return;
6477 }
6478
6479 if ( dragRow >= 0 )
6480 {
6481 m_dragRowOrCol = dragRow;
6482
6483 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6484 {
6485 if ( CanDragRowSize() && CanDragGridSize() )
6486 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, NULL, false);
6487 }
6488 }
6489 else if ( dragCol >= 0 )
6490 {
6491 m_dragRowOrCol = dragCol;
6492
6493 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6494 {
6495 if ( CanDragColSize() && CanDragGridSize() )
6496 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, NULL, false);
6497 }
6498 }
6499 else // Neither on a row or col edge
6500 {
6501 if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6502 {
6503 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6504 }
6505 }
6506 }
6507
6508 void wxGrid::ProcessGridCellMouseEvent(wxMouseEvent& event)
6509 {
6510 const wxPoint pos = CalcUnscrolledPosition(event.GetPosition());
6511
6512 // coordinates of the cell under mouse
6513 wxGridCellCoords coords = XYToCell(pos);
6514
6515 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
6516 GetCellSize( coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol(), &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
6517 if ( (cell_rows < 0) || (cell_cols < 0) )
6518 {
6519 coords.SetRow(coords.GetRow() + cell_rows);
6520 coords.SetCol(coords.GetCol() + cell_cols);
6521 }
6522
6523 if ( event.Dragging() )
6524 {
6525 if ( event.LeftIsDown() )
6526 DoGridDragEvent(event, coords);
6527 else
6528 event.Skip();
6529 return;
6530 }
6531
6532 m_isDragging = false;
6533 m_startDragPos = wxDefaultPosition;
6534
6535 // VZ: if we do this, the mode is reset to WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL
6536 // immediately after it becomes WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW/COL under
6537 // wxGTK
6538 #if 0
6539 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
6540 {
6541 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6542 m_gridWin->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
6543 }
6544 #endif // 0
6545
6546 // deal with various button presses
6547 if ( event.IsButton() )
6548 {
6549 if ( coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6550 {
6551 DisableCellEditControl();
6552
6553 if ( event.LeftDown() )
6554 DoGridCellLeftDown(event, coords, pos);
6555 else if ( event.LeftDClick() )
6556 DoGridCellLeftDClick(event, coords, pos);
6557 else if ( event.RightDown() )
6558 SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_CLICK, coords, event);
6559 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
6560 SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_DCLICK, coords, event);
6561 }
6562
6563 // this one should be called even if we're not over any cell
6564 if ( event.LeftUp() )
6565 {
6566 DoGridCellLeftUp(event, coords);
6567 }
6568 }
6569 else if ( event.Moving() )
6570 {
6571 DoGridMouseMoveEvent(event, coords, pos);
6572 }
6573 else // unknown mouse event?
6574 {
6575 event.Skip();
6576 }
6577 }
6578
6579 void wxGrid::DoEndDragResizeLine(const wxGridOperations& oper)
6580 {
6581 if ( m_dragLastPos == -1 )
6582 return;
6583
6584 const wxGridOperations& doper = oper.Dual();
6585
6586 const wxSize size = m_gridWin->GetClientSize();
6587
6588 const wxPoint ptOrigin = CalcUnscrolledPosition(wxPoint(0, 0));
6589
6590 // erase the last line we drew
6591 wxClientDC dc(m_gridWin);
6592 PrepareDC(dc);
6593 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
6594
6595 const int posLineStart = oper.Select(ptOrigin);
6596 const int posLineEnd = oper.Select(ptOrigin) + oper.Select(size);
6597
6598 oper.DrawParallelLine(dc, posLineStart, posLineEnd, m_dragLastPos);
6599
6600 // temporarily hide the edit control before resizing
6601 HideCellEditControl();
6602 SaveEditControlValue();
6603
6604 // do resize the line
6605 const int lineStart = oper.GetLineStartPos(this, m_dragRowOrCol);
6606 oper.SetLineSize(this, m_dragRowOrCol,
6607 wxMax(m_dragLastPos - lineStart,
6608 oper.GetMinimalLineSize(this, m_dragRowOrCol)));
6609
6610 // refresh now if we're not frozen
6611 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
6612 {
6613 // we need to refresh everything beyond the resized line in the header
6614 // window
6615
6616 // get the position from which to refresh in the other direction
6617 wxRect rect(CellToRect(oper.MakeCoords(m_dragRowOrCol, 0)));
6618 rect.SetPosition(CalcScrolledPosition(rect.GetPosition()));
6619
6620 // we only need the ordinate (for rows) or abscissa (for columns) here,
6621 // and need to cover the entire window in the other direction
6622 oper.Select(rect) = 0;
6623
6624 wxRect rectHeader(rect.GetPosition(),
6625 oper.MakeSize
6626 (
6627 oper.GetHeaderWindowSize(this),
6628 doper.Select(size) - doper.Select(rect)
6629 ));
6630
6631 oper.GetHeaderWindow(this)->Refresh(true, &rectHeader);
6632
6633
6634 // also refresh the grid window: extend the rectangle
6635 if ( m_table )
6636 {
6637 oper.SelectSize(rect) = oper.Select(size);
6638
6639 int subtractLines = 0;
6640 const int lineStart = oper.PosToLine(this, posLineStart);
6641 if ( lineStart >= 0 )
6642 {
6643 // ensure that if we have a multi-cell block we redraw all of
6644 // it by increasing the refresh area to cover it entirely if a
6645 // part of it is affected
6646 const int lineEnd = oper.PosToLine(this, posLineEnd, true);
6647 for ( int line = lineStart; line < lineEnd; line++ )
6648 {
6649 int cellLines = oper.Select(
6650 GetCellSize(oper.MakeCoords(m_dragRowOrCol, line)));
6651 if ( cellLines < subtractLines )
6652 subtractLines = cellLines;
6653 }
6654 }
6655
6656 int startPos =
6657 oper.GetLineStartPos(this, m_dragRowOrCol + subtractLines);
6658 startPos = doper.CalcScrolledPosition(this, startPos);
6659
6660 doper.Select(rect) = startPos;
6661 doper.SelectSize(rect) = doper.Select(size) - startPos;
6662
6663 m_gridWin->Refresh(false, &rect);
6664 }
6665 }
6666
6667 // show the edit control back again
6668 ShowCellEditControl();
6669 }
6670
6671 void wxGrid::DoEndDragResizeRow()
6672 {
6673 DoEndDragResizeLine(wxGridRowOperations());
6674 }
6675
6676 void wxGrid::DoEndDragResizeCol()
6677 {
6678 DoEndDragResizeLine(wxGridColumnOperations());
6679 }
6680
6681 void wxGrid::DoEndDragMoveCol()
6682 {
6683 //The user clicked on the column but didn't actually drag
6684 if ( m_dragLastPos < 0 )
6685 {
6686 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(); //Do this to "unpress" the column
6687 return;
6688 }
6689
6690 int newPos;
6691 if ( m_moveToCol == -1 )
6692 newPos = m_numCols - 1;
6693 else
6694 {
6695 newPos = GetColPos( m_moveToCol );
6696 if ( newPos > GetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol ) )
6697 newPos--;
6698 }
6699
6700 SetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol, newPos );
6701 }
6702
6703 void wxGrid::SetColPos( int colID, int newPos )
6704 {
6705 if ( m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
6706 {
6707 m_colAt.Alloc( m_numCols );
6708
6709 int i;
6710 for ( i = 0; i < m_numCols; i++ )
6711 {
6712 m_colAt.Add( i );
6713 }
6714 }
6715
6716 int oldPos = GetColPos( colID );
6717
6718 //Reshuffle the m_colAt array
6719 if ( newPos > oldPos )
6720 {
6721 int i;
6722 for ( i = oldPos; i < newPos; i++ )
6723 {
6724 m_colAt[i] = m_colAt[i+1];
6725 }
6726 }
6727 else
6728 {
6729 int i;
6730 for ( i = oldPos; i > newPos; i-- )
6731 {
6732 m_colAt[i] = m_colAt[i-1];
6733 }
6734 }
6735
6736 m_colAt[newPos] = colID;
6737
6738 //Recalculate the column rights
6739 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
6740 {
6741 int colRight = 0;
6742 int colPos;
6743 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
6744 {
6745 int colID = GetColAt( colPos );
6746
6747 colRight += m_colWidths[colID];
6748 m_colRights[colID] = colRight;
6749 }
6750 }
6751
6752 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
6753 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6754 }
6755
6756
6757
6758 void wxGrid::EnableDragColMove( bool enable )
6759 {
6760 if ( m_canDragColMove == enable )
6761 return;
6762
6763 m_canDragColMove = enable;
6764
6765 if ( !m_canDragColMove )
6766 {
6767 m_colAt.Clear();
6768
6769 //Recalculate the column rights
6770 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
6771 {
6772 int colRight = 0;
6773 int colPos;
6774 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
6775 {
6776 colRight += m_colWidths[colPos];
6777 m_colRights[colPos] = colRight;
6778 }
6779 }
6780
6781 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
6782 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6783 }
6784 }
6785
6786
6787 //
6788 // ------ interaction with data model
6789 //
6790 bool wxGrid::ProcessTableMessage( wxGridTableMessage& msg )
6791 {
6792 switch ( msg.GetId() )
6793 {
6794 case wxGRIDTABLE_REQUEST_VIEW_GET_VALUES:
6795 return GetModelValues();
6796
6797 case wxGRIDTABLE_REQUEST_VIEW_SEND_VALUES:
6798 return SetModelValues();
6799
6800 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED:
6801 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED:
6802 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED:
6803 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED:
6804 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED:
6805 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED:
6806 return Redimension( msg );
6807
6808 default:
6809 return false;
6810 }
6811 }
6812
6813 // The behaviour of this function depends on the grid table class
6814 // Clear() function. For the default wxGridStringTable class the
6815 // behaviour is to replace all cell contents with wxEmptyString but
6816 // not to change the number of rows or cols.
6817 //
6818 void wxGrid::ClearGrid()
6819 {
6820 if ( m_table )
6821 {
6822 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6823 DisableCellEditControl();
6824
6825 m_table->Clear();
6826 if (!GetBatchCount())
6827 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6828 }
6829 }
6830
6831 bool
6832 wxGrid::DoModifyLines(bool (wxGridTableBase::*funcModify)(size_t, size_t),
6833 int pos, int num, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6834 {
6835 wxCHECK_MSG( m_created, false, "must finish creating the grid first" );
6836
6837 if ( !m_table )
6838 return false;
6839
6840 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
6841 DisableCellEditControl();
6842
6843 return (m_table->*funcModify)(pos, num);
6844
6845 // the table will have sent the results of the insert row
6846 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6847 }
6848
6849 bool
6850 wxGrid::DoAppendLines(bool (wxGridTableBase::*funcAppend)(size_t),
6851 int num, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels))
6852 {
6853 wxCHECK_MSG( m_created, false, "must finish creating the grid first" );
6854
6855 if ( !m_table )
6856 return false;
6857
6858 return (m_table->*funcAppend)(num);
6859 }
6860
6861 //
6862 // ----- event handlers
6863 //
6864
6865 // Generate a grid event based on a mouse event and return:
6866 // -1 if the event was vetoed
6867 // +1 if the event was processed (but not vetoed)
6868 // 0 if the event wasn't handled
6869 int
6870 wxGrid::SendEvent(const wxEventType type,
6871 int row, int col,
6872 wxMouseEvent& mouseEv)
6873 {
6874 bool claimed, vetoed;
6875
6876 if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE || type == wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE )
6877 {
6878 int rowOrCol = (row == -1 ? col : row);
6879
6880 wxGridSizeEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6881 type,
6882 this,
6883 rowOrCol,
6884 mouseEv.GetX() + GetRowLabelSize(),
6885 mouseEv.GetY() + GetColLabelSize(),
6886 mouseEv);
6887
6888 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6889 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6890 }
6891 else if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_RANGE_SELECT )
6892 {
6893 // Right now, it should _never_ end up here!
6894 wxGridRangeSelectEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6895 type,
6896 this,
6897 m_selectedBlockTopLeft,
6898 m_selectedBlockBottomRight,
6899 true,
6900 mouseEv);
6901
6902 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6903 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6904 }
6905 else if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK ||
6906 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK ||
6907 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK ||
6908 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK )
6909 {
6910 wxPoint pos = mouseEv.GetPosition();
6911
6912 if ( mouseEv.GetEventObject() == GetGridRowLabelWindow() )
6913 pos.y += GetColLabelSize();
6914 if ( mouseEv.GetEventObject() == GetGridColLabelWindow() )
6915 pos.x += GetRowLabelSize();
6916
6917 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6918 type,
6919 this,
6920 row, col,
6921 pos.x,
6922 pos.y,
6923 false,
6924 mouseEv);
6925 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6926 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6927 }
6928 else
6929 {
6930 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6931 type,
6932 this,
6933 row, col,
6934 mouseEv.GetX() + GetRowLabelSize(),
6935 mouseEv.GetY() + GetColLabelSize(),
6936 false,
6937 mouseEv);
6938 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6939 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6940 }
6941
6942 // A Veto'd event may not be `claimed' so test this first
6943 if (vetoed)
6944 return -1;
6945
6946 return claimed ? 1 : 0;
6947 }
6948
6949 // Generate a grid event of specified type, return value same as above
6950 //
6951 int wxGrid::SendEvent(const wxEventType type, int row, int col)
6952 {
6953 bool claimed, vetoed;
6954
6955 if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE || type == wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE )
6956 {
6957 int rowOrCol = (row == -1 ? col : row);
6958
6959 wxGridSizeEvent gridEvt( GetId(), type, this, rowOrCol );
6960
6961 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6962 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6963 }
6964 else
6965 {
6966 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(), type, this, row, col );
6967
6968 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6969 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6970 }
6971
6972 // A Veto'd event may not be `claimed' so test this first
6973 if (vetoed)
6974 return -1;
6975
6976 return claimed ? 1 : 0;
6977 }
6978
6979 void wxGrid::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
6980 {
6981 // needed to prevent zillions of paint events on MSW
6982 wxPaintDC dc(this);
6983 }
6984
6985 void wxGrid::Refresh(bool eraseb, const wxRect* rect)
6986 {
6987 // Don't do anything if between Begin/EndBatch...
6988 // EndBatch() will do all this on the last nested one anyway.
6989 if ( m_created && !GetBatchCount() )
6990 {
6991 // Refresh to get correct scrolled position:
6992 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh(eraseb, rect);
6993
6994 if (rect)
6995 {
6996 int rect_x, rect_y, rectWidth, rectHeight;
6997 int width_label, width_cell, height_label, height_cell;
6998 int x, y;
6999
7000 // Copy rectangle can get scroll offsets..
7001 rect_x = rect->GetX();
7002 rect_y = rect->GetY();
7003 rectWidth = rect->GetWidth();
7004 rectHeight = rect->GetHeight();
7005
7006 width_label = m_rowLabelWidth - rect_x;
7007 if (width_label > rectWidth)
7008 width_label = rectWidth;
7009
7010 height_label = m_colLabelHeight - rect_y;
7011 if (height_label > rectHeight)
7012 height_label = rectHeight;
7013
7014 if (rect_x > m_rowLabelWidth)
7015 {
7016 x = rect_x - m_rowLabelWidth;
7017 width_cell = rectWidth;
7018 }
7019 else
7020 {
7021 x = 0;
7022 width_cell = rectWidth - (m_rowLabelWidth - rect_x);
7023 }
7024
7025 if (rect_y > m_colLabelHeight)
7026 {
7027 y = rect_y - m_colLabelHeight;
7028 height_cell = rectHeight;
7029 }
7030 else
7031 {
7032 y = 0;
7033 height_cell = rectHeight - (m_colLabelHeight - rect_y);
7034 }
7035
7036 // Paint corner label part intersecting rect.
7037 if ( width_label > 0 && height_label > 0 )
7038 {
7039 wxRect anotherrect(rect_x, rect_y, width_label, height_label);
7040 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
7041 }
7042
7043 // Paint col labels part intersecting rect.
7044 if ( width_cell > 0 && height_label > 0 )
7045 {
7046 wxRect anotherrect(x, rect_y, width_cell, height_label);
7047 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
7048 }
7049
7050 // Paint row labels part intersecting rect.
7051 if ( width_label > 0 && height_cell > 0 )
7052 {
7053 wxRect anotherrect(rect_x, y, width_label, height_cell);
7054 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
7055 }
7056
7057 // Paint cell area part intersecting rect.
7058 if ( width_cell > 0 && height_cell > 0 )
7059 {
7060 wxRect anotherrect(x, y, width_cell, height_cell);
7061 m_gridWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
7062 }
7063 }
7064 else
7065 {
7066 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
7067 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
7068 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
7069 m_gridWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
7070 }
7071 }
7072 }
7073
7074 void wxGrid::OnSize(wxSizeEvent& WXUNUSED(event))
7075 {
7076 if (m_targetWindow != this) // check whether initialisation has been done
7077 {
7078 // reposition our children windows
7079 CalcWindowSizes();
7080 }
7081 }
7082
7083 void wxGrid::OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& event )
7084 {
7085 if ( m_inOnKeyDown )
7086 {
7087 // shouldn't be here - we are going round in circles...
7088 //
7089 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("wxGrid::OnKeyDown called while already active") );
7090 }
7091
7092 m_inOnKeyDown = true;
7093
7094 // propagate the event up and see if it gets processed
7095 wxWindow *parent = GetParent();
7096 wxKeyEvent keyEvt( event );
7097 keyEvt.SetEventObject( parent );
7098
7099 if ( !parent->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( keyEvt ) )
7100 {
7101 if (GetLayoutDirection() == wxLayout_RightToLeft)
7102 {
7103 if (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_RIGHT)
7104 event.m_keyCode = WXK_LEFT;
7105 else if (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_LEFT)
7106 event.m_keyCode = WXK_RIGHT;
7107 }
7108
7109 // try local handlers
7110 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
7111 {
7112 case WXK_UP:
7113 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7114 MoveCursorUpBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7115 else
7116 MoveCursorUp( event.ShiftDown() );
7117 break;
7118
7119 case WXK_DOWN:
7120 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7121 MoveCursorDownBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7122 else
7123 MoveCursorDown( event.ShiftDown() );
7124 break;
7125
7126 case WXK_LEFT:
7127 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7128 MoveCursorLeftBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7129 else
7130 MoveCursorLeft( event.ShiftDown() );
7131 break;
7132
7133 case WXK_RIGHT:
7134 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7135 MoveCursorRightBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7136 else
7137 MoveCursorRight( event.ShiftDown() );
7138 break;
7139
7140 case WXK_RETURN:
7141 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
7142 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7143 {
7144 event.Skip(); // to let the edit control have the return
7145 }
7146 else
7147 {
7148 if ( GetGridCursorRow() < GetNumberRows()-1 )
7149 {
7150 MoveCursorDown( event.ShiftDown() );
7151 }
7152 else
7153 {
7154 // at the bottom of a column
7155 DisableCellEditControl();
7156 }
7157 }
7158 break;
7159
7160 case WXK_ESCAPE:
7161 ClearSelection();
7162 break;
7163
7164 case WXK_TAB:
7165 if (event.ShiftDown())
7166 {
7167 if ( GetGridCursorCol() > 0 )
7168 {
7169 MoveCursorLeft( false );
7170 }
7171 else
7172 {
7173 // at left of grid
7174 DisableCellEditControl();
7175 }
7176 }
7177 else
7178 {
7179 if ( GetGridCursorCol() < GetNumberCols() - 1 )
7180 {
7181 MoveCursorRight( false );
7182 }
7183 else
7184 {
7185 // at right of grid
7186 DisableCellEditControl();
7187 }
7188 }
7189 break;
7190
7191 case WXK_HOME:
7192 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7193 {
7194 GoToCell(0, 0);
7195 }
7196 else
7197 {
7198 event.Skip();
7199 }
7200 break;
7201
7202 case WXK_END:
7203 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7204 {
7205 GoToCell(m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1);
7206 }
7207 else
7208 {
7209 event.Skip();
7210 }
7211 break;
7212
7213 case WXK_PAGEUP:
7214 MovePageUp();
7215 break;
7216
7217 case WXK_PAGEDOWN:
7218 MovePageDown();
7219 break;
7220
7221 case WXK_SPACE:
7222 // Ctrl-Space selects the current column, Shift-Space -- the
7223 // current row and Ctrl-Shift-Space -- everything
7224 switch ( m_selection ? event.GetModifiers() : wxMOD_NONE )
7225 {
7226 case wxMOD_CONTROL:
7227 m_selection->SelectCol(m_currentCellCoords.GetCol());
7228 break;
7229
7230 case wxMOD_SHIFT:
7231 m_selection->SelectRow(m_currentCellCoords.GetRow());
7232 break;
7233
7234 case wxMOD_CONTROL | wxMOD_SHIFT:
7235 m_selection->SelectBlock(0, 0,
7236 m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1);
7237 break;
7238
7239 case wxMOD_NONE:
7240 if ( !IsEditable() )
7241 {
7242 MoveCursorRight(false);
7243 break;
7244 }
7245 //else: fall through
7246
7247 default:
7248 event.Skip();
7249 }
7250 break;
7251
7252 default:
7253 event.Skip();
7254 break;
7255 }
7256 }
7257
7258 m_inOnKeyDown = false;
7259 }
7260
7261 void wxGrid::OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& event )
7262 {
7263 // try local handlers
7264 //
7265 if ( event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_SHIFT )
7266 {
7267 if ( m_selectedBlockTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
7268 m_selectedBlockBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords )
7269 {
7270 if ( m_selection )
7271 {
7272 m_selection->SelectBlock(
7273 m_selectedBlockTopLeft,
7274 m_selectedBlockBottomRight,
7275 event);
7276 }
7277 }
7278
7279 m_selectedBlockTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7280 m_selectedBlockBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7281 m_selectedBlockCorner = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7282 }
7283 }
7284
7285 void wxGrid::OnChar( wxKeyEvent& event )
7286 {
7287 // is it possible to edit the current cell at all?
7288 if ( !IsCellEditControlEnabled() && CanEnableCellControl() )
7289 {
7290 // yes, now check whether the cells editor accepts the key
7291 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
7292 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
7293 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
7294 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
7295
7296 // <F2> is special and will always start editing, for
7297 // other keys - ask the editor itself
7298 if ( (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_F2 && !event.HasModifiers())
7299 || editor->IsAcceptedKey(event) )
7300 {
7301 // ensure cell is visble
7302 MakeCellVisible(row, col);
7303 EnableCellEditControl();
7304
7305 // a problem can arise if the cell is not completely
7306 // visible (even after calling MakeCellVisible the
7307 // control is not created and calling StartingKey will
7308 // crash the app
7309 if ( event.GetKeyCode() != WXK_F2 && editor->IsCreated() && m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
7310 editor->StartingKey(event);
7311 }
7312 else
7313 {
7314 event.Skip();
7315 }
7316
7317 editor->DecRef();
7318 attr->DecRef();
7319 }
7320 else
7321 {
7322 event.Skip();
7323 }
7324 }
7325
7326 void wxGrid::OnEraseBackground(wxEraseEvent&)
7327 {
7328 }
7329
7330 bool wxGrid::SetCurrentCell( const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7331 {
7332 if ( SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_SELECT_CELL, coords) == -1 )
7333 {
7334 // the event has been vetoed - do nothing
7335 return false;
7336 }
7337
7338 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7339 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
7340 PrepareDC( dc );
7341 #endif
7342
7343 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
7344 {
7345 DisableCellEditControl();
7346
7347 if ( IsVisible( m_currentCellCoords, false ) )
7348 {
7349 wxRect r;
7350 r = BlockToDeviceRect( m_currentCellCoords, m_currentCellCoords );
7351 if ( !m_gridLinesEnabled )
7352 {
7353 r.x--;
7354 r.y--;
7355 r.width++;
7356 r.height++;
7357 }
7358
7359 wxGridCellCoordsArray cells = CalcCellsExposed( r );
7360
7361 // Otherwise refresh redraws the highlight!
7362 m_currentCellCoords = coords;
7363
7364 #if defined(__WXMAC__)
7365 m_gridWin->Refresh(true /*, & r */);
7366 #else
7367 DrawGridCellArea( dc, cells );
7368 DrawAllGridLines( dc, r );
7369 #endif
7370 }
7371 }
7372
7373 m_currentCellCoords = coords;
7374
7375 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr( coords );
7376 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7377 DrawCellHighlight( dc, attr );
7378 #endif
7379 attr->DecRef();
7380
7381 return true;
7382 }
7383
7384 void
7385 wxGrid::UpdateBlockBeingSelected(int topRow, int leftCol,
7386 int bottomRow, int rightCol)
7387 {
7388 if ( m_selection )
7389 {
7390 switch ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() )
7391 {
7392 default:
7393 wxFAIL_MSG( "unknown selection mode" );
7394 // fall through
7395
7396 case wxGridSelectCells:
7397 // arbitrary blocks selection allowed so just use the cell
7398 // coordinates as is
7399 break;
7400
7401 case wxGridSelectRows:
7402 // only full rows selection allowd, ensure that we do select
7403 // full rows
7404 leftCol = 0;
7405 rightCol = GetNumberCols() - 1;
7406 break;
7407
7408 case wxGridSelectColumns:
7409 // same as above but for columns
7410 topRow = 0;
7411 bottomRow = GetNumberRows() - 1;
7412 break;
7413
7414 case wxGridSelectRowsOrColumns:
7415 // in this mode we can select only full rows or full columns so
7416 // it doesn't make sense to select blocks at all (and we can't
7417 // extend the block because there is no preferred direction, we
7418 // could only extend it to cover the entire grid but this is
7419 // not useful)
7420 return;
7421 }
7422 }
7423
7424 m_selectedBlockCorner = wxGridCellCoords(bottomRow, rightCol);
7425 MakeCellVisible(m_selectedBlockCorner);
7426
7427 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(topRow, bottomRow);
7428 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(leftCol, rightCol);
7429
7430 wxGridCellCoords updateTopLeft = wxGridCellCoords(topRow, leftCol),
7431 updateBottomRight = wxGridCellCoords(bottomRow, rightCol);
7432
7433 // First the case that we selected a completely new area
7434 if ( m_selectedBlockTopLeft == wxGridNoCellCoords ||
7435 m_selectedBlockBottomRight == wxGridNoCellCoords )
7436 {
7437 wxRect rect;
7438 rect = BlockToDeviceRect( wxGridCellCoords ( topRow, leftCol ),
7439 wxGridCellCoords ( bottomRow, rightCol ) );
7440 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
7441 }
7442
7443 // Now handle changing an existing selection area.
7444 else if ( m_selectedBlockTopLeft != updateTopLeft ||
7445 m_selectedBlockBottomRight != updateBottomRight )
7446 {
7447 // Compute two optimal update rectangles:
7448 // Either one rectangle is a real subset of the
7449 // other, or they are (almost) disjoint!
7450 wxRect rect[4];
7451 bool need_refresh[4];
7452 need_refresh[0] =
7453 need_refresh[1] =
7454 need_refresh[2] =
7455 need_refresh[3] = false;
7456 int i;
7457
7458 // Store intermediate values
7459 wxCoord oldLeft = m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetCol();
7460 wxCoord oldTop = m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetRow();
7461 wxCoord oldRight = m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetCol();
7462 wxCoord oldBottom = m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetRow();
7463
7464 // Determine the outer/inner coordinates.
7465 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(oldLeft, leftCol);
7466 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(oldTop, topRow);
7467 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(rightCol, oldRight);
7468 EnsureFirstLessThanSecond(bottomRow, oldBottom);
7469
7470 // Now, either the stuff marked old is the outer
7471 // rectangle or we don't have a situation where one
7472 // is contained in the other.
7473
7474 if ( oldLeft < leftCol )
7475 {
7476 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7477 // area to the left of the old or new selection.
7478 need_refresh[0] = true;
7479 rect[0] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7480 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, oldLeft ),
7481 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, leftCol - 1 ) );
7482 }
7483
7484 if ( oldTop < topRow )
7485 {
7486 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7487 // area above the old or new selection.
7488 need_refresh[1] = true;
7489 rect[1] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7490 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, leftCol ),
7491 wxGridCellCoords( topRow - 1, rightCol ) );
7492 }
7493
7494 if ( oldRight > rightCol )
7495 {
7496 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7497 // area to the right of the old or new selection.
7498 need_refresh[2] = true;
7499 rect[2] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7500 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, rightCol + 1 ),
7501 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, oldRight ) );
7502 }
7503
7504 if ( oldBottom > bottomRow )
7505 {
7506 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7507 // area below the old or new selection.
7508 need_refresh[3] = true;
7509 rect[3] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7510 wxGridCellCoords( bottomRow + 1, leftCol ),
7511 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, rightCol ) );
7512 }
7513
7514 // various Refresh() calls
7515 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++ )
7516 if ( need_refresh[i] && rect[i] != wxGridNoCellRect )
7517 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &(rect[i]) );
7518 }
7519
7520 // change selection
7521 m_selectedBlockTopLeft = updateTopLeft;
7522 m_selectedBlockBottomRight = updateBottomRight;
7523 }
7524
7525 //
7526 // ------ functions to get/send data (see also public functions)
7527 //
7528
7529 bool wxGrid::GetModelValues()
7530 {
7531 // Hide the editor, so it won't hide a changed value.
7532 HideCellEditControl();
7533
7534 if ( m_table )
7535 {
7536 // all we need to do is repaint the grid
7537 //
7538 m_gridWin->Refresh();
7539 return true;
7540 }
7541
7542 return false;
7543 }
7544
7545 bool wxGrid::SetModelValues()
7546 {
7547 int row, col;
7548
7549 // Disable the editor, so it won't hide a changed value.
7550 // Do we also want to save the current value of the editor first?
7551 // I think so ...
7552 DisableCellEditControl();
7553
7554 if ( m_table )
7555 {
7556 for ( row = 0; row < m_numRows; row++ )
7557 {
7558 for ( col = 0; col < m_numCols; col++ )
7559 {
7560 m_table->SetValue( row, col, GetCellValue(row, col) );
7561 }
7562 }
7563
7564 return true;
7565 }
7566
7567 return false;
7568 }
7569
7570 // Note - this function only draws cells that are in the list of
7571 // exposed cells (usually set from the update region by
7572 // CalcExposedCells)
7573 //
7574 void wxGrid::DrawGridCellArea( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoordsArray& cells )
7575 {
7576 if ( !m_numRows || !m_numCols )
7577 return;
7578
7579 int i, numCells = cells.GetCount();
7580 int row, col, cell_rows, cell_cols;
7581 wxGridCellCoordsArray redrawCells;
7582
7583 for ( i = numCells - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
7584 {
7585 row = cells[i].GetRow();
7586 col = cells[i].GetCol();
7587 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
7588
7589 // If this cell is part of a multicell block, find owner for repaint
7590 if ( cell_rows <= 0 || cell_cols <= 0 )
7591 {
7592 wxGridCellCoords cell( row + cell_rows, col + cell_cols );
7593 bool marked = false;
7594 for ( int j = 0; j < numCells; j++ )
7595 {
7596 if ( cell == cells[j] )
7597 {
7598 marked = true;
7599 break;
7600 }
7601 }
7602
7603 if (!marked)
7604 {
7605 int count = redrawCells.GetCount();
7606 for (int j = 0; j < count; j++)
7607 {
7608 if ( cell == redrawCells[j] )
7609 {
7610 marked = true;
7611 break;
7612 }
7613 }
7614
7615 if (!marked)
7616 redrawCells.Add( cell );
7617 }
7618
7619 // don't bother drawing this cell
7620 continue;
7621 }
7622
7623 // If this cell is empty, find cell to left that might want to overflow
7624 if (m_table && m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col))
7625 {
7626 for ( int l = 0; l < cell_rows; l++ )
7627 {
7628 // find a cell in this row to leave already marked for repaint
7629 int left = col;
7630 for (int k = 0; k < int(redrawCells.GetCount()); k++)
7631 if ((redrawCells[k].GetCol() < left) &&
7632 (redrawCells[k].GetRow() == row))
7633 {
7634 left = redrawCells[k].GetCol();
7635 }
7636
7637 if (left == col)
7638 left = 0; // oh well
7639
7640 for (int j = col - 1; j >= left; j--)
7641 {
7642 if (!m_table->IsEmptyCell(row + l, j))
7643 {
7644 if (GetCellOverflow(row + l, j))
7645 {
7646 wxGridCellCoords cell(row + l, j);
7647 bool marked = false;
7648
7649 for (int k = 0; k < numCells; k++)
7650 {
7651 if ( cell == cells[k] )
7652 {
7653 marked = true;
7654 break;
7655 }
7656 }
7657
7658 if (!marked)
7659 {
7660 int count = redrawCells.GetCount();
7661 for (int k = 0; k < count; k++)
7662 {
7663 if ( cell == redrawCells[k] )
7664 {
7665 marked = true;
7666 break;
7667 }
7668 }
7669 if (!marked)
7670 redrawCells.Add( cell );
7671 }
7672 }
7673 break;
7674 }
7675 }
7676 }
7677 }
7678
7679 DrawCell( dc, cells[i] );
7680 }
7681
7682 numCells = redrawCells.GetCount();
7683
7684 for ( i = numCells - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
7685 {
7686 DrawCell( dc, redrawCells[i] );
7687 }
7688 }
7689
7690 void wxGrid::DrawGridSpace( wxDC& dc )
7691 {
7692 int cw, ch;
7693 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
7694
7695 int right, bottom;
7696 CalcUnscrolledPosition( cw, ch, &right, &bottom );
7697
7698 int rightCol = m_numCols > 0 ? GetColRight(GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 )) : 0;
7699 int bottomRow = m_numRows > 0 ? GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1) : 0;
7700
7701 if ( right > rightCol || bottom > bottomRow )
7702 {
7703 int left, top;
7704 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &top );
7705
7706 dc.SetBrush(GetDefaultCellBackgroundColour());
7707 dc.SetPen( *wxTRANSPARENT_PEN );
7708
7709 if ( right > rightCol )
7710 {
7711 dc.DrawRectangle( rightCol, top, right - rightCol, ch );
7712 }
7713
7714 if ( bottom > bottomRow )
7715 {
7716 dc.DrawRectangle( left, bottomRow, cw, bottom - bottomRow );
7717 }
7718 }
7719 }
7720
7721 void wxGrid::DrawCell( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7722 {
7723 int row = coords.GetRow();
7724 int col = coords.GetCol();
7725
7726 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7727 return;
7728
7729 // we draw the cell border ourselves
7730 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
7731
7732 bool isCurrent = coords == m_currentCellCoords;
7733
7734 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, col );
7735
7736 // if the editor is shown, we should use it and not the renderer
7737 // Note: However, only if it is really _shown_, i.e. not hidden!
7738 if ( isCurrent && IsCellEditControlShown() )
7739 {
7740 // NB: this "#if..." is temporary and fixes a problem where the
7741 // edit control is erased by this code after being rendered.
7742 // On wxMac (QD build only), the cell editor is a wxTextCntl and is rendered
7743 // implicitly, causing this out-of order render.
7744 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7745 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
7746 editor->PaintBackground(rect, attr);
7747 editor->DecRef();
7748 #endif
7749 }
7750 else
7751 {
7752 // but all the rest is drawn by the cell renderer and hence may be customized
7753 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
7754 renderer->Draw(*this, *attr, dc, rect, row, col, IsInSelection(coords));
7755 renderer->DecRef();
7756 }
7757
7758 attr->DecRef();
7759 }
7760
7761 void wxGrid::DrawCellHighlight( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellAttr *attr )
7762 {
7763 // don't show highlight when the grid doesn't have focus
7764 if ( !HasFocus() )
7765 return;
7766
7767 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
7768 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
7769
7770 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7771 return;
7772
7773 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
7774
7775 // hmmm... what could we do here to show that the cell is disabled?
7776 // for now, I just draw a thinner border than for the other ones, but
7777 // it doesn't look really good
7778
7779 int penWidth = attr->IsReadOnly() ? m_cellHighlightROPenWidth : m_cellHighlightPenWidth;
7780
7781 if (penWidth > 0)
7782 {
7783 // The center of the drawn line is where the position/width/height of
7784 // the rectangle is actually at (on wxMSW at least), so the
7785 // size of the rectangle is reduced to compensate for the thickness of
7786 // the line. If this is too strange on non-wxMSW platforms then
7787 // please #ifdef this appropriately.
7788 rect.x += penWidth / 2;
7789 rect.y += penWidth / 2;
7790 rect.width -= penWidth - 1;
7791 rect.height -= penWidth - 1;
7792
7793 // Now draw the rectangle
7794 // use the cellHighlightColour if the cell is inside a selection, this
7795 // will ensure the cell is always visible.
7796 dc.SetPen(wxPen(IsInSelection(row,col) ? m_selectionForeground
7797 : m_cellHighlightColour,
7798 penWidth));
7799 dc.SetBrush(*wxTRANSPARENT_BRUSH);
7800 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
7801 }
7802 }
7803
7804 wxPen wxGrid::GetDefaultGridLinePen()
7805 {
7806 return wxPen(GetGridLineColour());
7807 }
7808
7809 wxPen wxGrid::GetRowGridLinePen(int WXUNUSED(row))
7810 {
7811 return GetDefaultGridLinePen();
7812 }
7813
7814 wxPen wxGrid::GetColGridLinePen(int WXUNUSED(col))
7815 {
7816 return GetDefaultGridLinePen();
7817 }
7818
7819 void wxGrid::DrawCellBorder( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7820 {
7821 int row = coords.GetRow();
7822 int col = coords.GetCol();
7823 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7824 return;
7825
7826
7827 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, col );
7828
7829 // right hand border
7830 dc.SetPen( GetColGridLinePen(col) );
7831 dc.DrawLine( rect.x + rect.width, rect.y,
7832 rect.x + rect.width, rect.y + rect.height + 1 );
7833
7834 // bottom border
7835 dc.SetPen( GetRowGridLinePen(row) );
7836 dc.DrawLine( rect.x, rect.y + rect.height,
7837 rect.x + rect.width, rect.y + rect.height);
7838 }
7839
7840 void wxGrid::DrawHighlight(wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoordsArray& cells)
7841 {
7842 // This if block was previously in wxGrid::OnPaint but that doesn't
7843 // seem to get called under wxGTK - MB
7844 //
7845 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords &&
7846 m_numRows && m_numCols )
7847 {
7848 m_currentCellCoords.Set(0, 0);
7849 }
7850
7851 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
7852 {
7853 // don't show highlight when the edit control is shown
7854 return;
7855 }
7856
7857 // if the active cell was repainted, repaint its highlight too because it
7858 // might have been damaged by the grid lines
7859 size_t count = cells.GetCount();
7860 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
7861 {
7862 wxGridCellCoords cell = cells[n];
7863
7864 // If we are using attributes, then we may have just exposed another
7865 // cell in a partially-visible merged cluster of cells. If the "anchor"
7866 // (upper left) cell of this merged cluster is the cell indicated by
7867 // m_currentCellCoords, then we need to refresh the cell highlight even
7868 // though the "anchor" itself is not part of our update segment.
7869 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
7870 {
7871 int rows = 0,
7872 cols = 0;
7873 GetCellSize(cell.GetRow(), cell.GetCol(), &rows, &cols);
7874
7875 if ( rows < 0 )
7876 cell.SetRow(cell.GetRow() + rows);
7877
7878 if ( cols < 0 )
7879 cell.SetCol(cell.GetCol() + cols);
7880 }
7881
7882 if ( cell == m_currentCellCoords )
7883 {
7884 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
7885 DrawCellHighlight(dc, attr);
7886 attr->DecRef();
7887
7888 break;
7889 }
7890 }
7891 }
7892
7893 // This is used to redraw all grid lines e.g. when the grid line colour
7894 // has been changed
7895 //
7896 void wxGrid::DrawAllGridLines( wxDC& dc, const wxRegion & WXUNUSED(reg) )
7897 {
7898 if ( !m_gridLinesEnabled )
7899 return;
7900
7901 int top, bottom, left, right;
7902
7903 int cw, ch;
7904 m_gridWin->GetClientSize(&cw, &ch);
7905 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &top );
7906 CalcUnscrolledPosition( cw, ch, &right, &bottom );
7907
7908 // avoid drawing grid lines past the last row and col
7909 if ( m_gridLinesClipHorz )
7910 {
7911 if ( !m_numCols )
7912 return;
7913
7914 const int lastColRight = GetColRight(GetColAt(m_numCols - 1));
7915 if ( right > lastColRight )
7916 right = lastColRight;
7917 }
7918
7919 if ( m_gridLinesClipVert )
7920 {
7921 if ( !m_numRows )
7922 return;
7923
7924 const int lastRowBottom = GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1);
7925 if ( bottom > lastRowBottom )
7926 bottom = lastRowBottom;
7927 }
7928
7929 // no gridlines inside multicells, clip them out
7930 int leftCol = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) );
7931 int topRow = internalYToRow(top);
7932 int rightCol = GetColPos( internalXToCol(right) );
7933 int bottomRow = internalYToRow(bottom);
7934
7935 wxRegion clippedcells(0, 0, cw, ch);
7936
7937 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
7938 wxRect rect;
7939
7940 for ( int j = topRow; j <= bottomRow; j++ )
7941 {
7942 for ( int colPos = leftCol; colPos <= rightCol; colPos++ )
7943 {
7944 int i = GetColAt( colPos );
7945
7946 GetCellSize( j, i, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
7947 if ((cell_rows > 1) || (cell_cols > 1))
7948 {
7949 rect = CellToRect(j,i);
7950 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
7951 clippedcells.Subtract(rect);
7952 }
7953 else if ((cell_rows < 0) || (cell_cols < 0))
7954 {
7955 rect = CellToRect(j + cell_rows, i + cell_cols);
7956 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
7957 clippedcells.Subtract(rect);
7958 }
7959 }
7960 }
7961
7962 dc.SetDeviceClippingRegion( clippedcells );
7963
7964
7965 // horizontal grid lines
7966 for ( int i = internalYToRow(top); i < m_numRows; i++ )
7967 {
7968 int bot = GetRowBottom(i) - 1;
7969
7970 if ( bot > bottom )
7971 break;
7972
7973 if ( bot >= top )
7974 {
7975 dc.SetPen( GetRowGridLinePen(i) );
7976 dc.DrawLine( left, bot, right, bot );
7977 }
7978 }
7979
7980 // vertical grid lines
7981 for ( int colPos = leftCol; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
7982 {
7983 int i = GetColAt( colPos );
7984
7985 int colRight = GetColRight(i);
7986 #ifdef __WXGTK__
7987 if (GetLayoutDirection() != wxLayout_RightToLeft)
7988 #endif
7989 colRight--;
7990
7991 if ( colRight > right )
7992 break;
7993
7994 if ( colRight >= left )
7995 {
7996 dc.SetPen( GetColGridLinePen(i) );
7997 dc.DrawLine( colRight, top, colRight, bottom );
7998 }
7999 }
8000
8001 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
8002 }
8003
8004 void wxGrid::DrawRowLabels( wxDC& dc, const wxArrayInt& rows)
8005 {
8006 if ( !m_numRows )
8007 return;
8008
8009 const size_t numLabels = rows.GetCount();
8010 for ( size_t i = 0; i < numLabels; i++ )
8011 {
8012 DrawRowLabel( dc, rows[i] );
8013 }
8014 }
8015
8016 void wxGrid::DrawRowLabel( wxDC& dc, int row )
8017 {
8018 if ( GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 || m_rowLabelWidth <= 0 )
8019 return;
8020
8021 wxRect rect;
8022
8023 int rowTop = GetRowTop(row),
8024 rowBottom = GetRowBottom(row) - 1;
8025
8026 dc.SetPen( wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW)));
8027 dc.DrawLine( m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowTop, m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowBottom );
8028 dc.DrawLine( 0, rowTop, 0, rowBottom );
8029 dc.DrawLine( 0, rowBottom, m_rowLabelWidth, rowBottom );
8030
8031 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
8032 dc.DrawLine( 1, rowTop, 1, rowBottom );
8033 dc.DrawLine( 1, rowTop, m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowTop );
8034
8035 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
8036 dc.SetTextForeground( GetLabelTextColour() );
8037 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
8038
8039 int hAlign, vAlign;
8040 GetRowLabelAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign );
8041
8042 rect.SetX( 2 );
8043 rect.SetY( GetRowTop(row) + 2 );
8044 rect.SetWidth( m_rowLabelWidth - 4 );
8045 rect.SetHeight( GetRowHeight(row) - 4 );
8046 DrawTextRectangle( dc, GetRowLabelValue( row ), rect, hAlign, vAlign );
8047 }
8048
8049 void wxGrid::SetUseNativeColLabels( bool native )
8050 {
8051 m_nativeColumnLabels = native;
8052 if (native)
8053 {
8054 int height = wxRendererNative::Get().GetHeaderButtonHeight( this );
8055 SetColLabelSize( height );
8056 }
8057
8058 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
8059 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh();
8060 }
8061
8062 void wxGrid::DrawColLabels( wxDC& dc,const wxArrayInt& cols )
8063 {
8064 if ( !m_numCols )
8065 return;
8066
8067 const size_t numLabels = cols.GetCount();
8068 for ( size_t i = 0; i < numLabels; i++ )
8069 {
8070 DrawColLabel( dc, cols[i] );
8071 }
8072 }
8073
8074 void wxGrid::DrawCornerLabel(wxDC& dc)
8075 {
8076 if ( m_nativeColumnLabels )
8077 {
8078 wxRect rect(wxSize(m_rowLabelWidth, m_colLabelHeight));
8079 rect.Deflate(1);
8080
8081 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawHeaderButton(m_cornerLabelWin, dc, rect, 0);
8082 }
8083 else
8084 {
8085 dc.SetPen(wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW)));
8086 dc.DrawLine( m_rowLabelWidth - 1, m_colLabelHeight - 1,
8087 m_rowLabelWidth - 1, 0 );
8088 dc.DrawLine( m_rowLabelWidth - 1, m_colLabelHeight - 1,
8089 0, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8090 dc.DrawLine( 0, 0, m_rowLabelWidth, 0 );
8091 dc.DrawLine( 0, 0, 0, m_colLabelHeight );
8092
8093 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
8094 dc.DrawLine( 1, 1, m_rowLabelWidth - 1, 1 );
8095 dc.DrawLine( 1, 1, 1, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8096 }
8097 }
8098
8099 void wxGrid::DrawColLabel(wxDC& dc, int col)
8100 {
8101 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || m_colLabelHeight <= 0 )
8102 return;
8103
8104 int colLeft = GetColLeft(col);
8105
8106 wxRect rect(colLeft, 0, GetColWidth(col), m_colLabelHeight);
8107
8108 if ( m_nativeColumnLabels )
8109 {
8110 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawHeaderButton(m_colLabelWin, dc, rect, 0);
8111 }
8112 else
8113 {
8114 int colRight = GetColRight(col) - 1;
8115
8116 dc.SetPen(wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW)));
8117 dc.DrawLine( colRight, 0,
8118 colRight, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8119 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 0,
8120 colRight, 0 );
8121 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, m_colLabelHeight - 1,
8122 colRight + 1, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8123
8124 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
8125 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colLeft, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8126 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colRight, 1 );
8127 }
8128
8129 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
8130 dc.SetTextForeground( GetLabelTextColour() );
8131 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
8132
8133 int hAlign, vAlign;
8134 GetColLabelAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign );
8135 const int orient = GetColLabelTextOrientation();
8136
8137 rect.Deflate(2);
8138 DrawTextRectangle(dc, GetColLabelValue(col), rect, hAlign, vAlign, orient);
8139 }
8140
8141 // TODO: these 2 functions should be replaced with wxDC::DrawLabel() to which
8142 // we just have to add textOrientation support
8143 void wxGrid::DrawTextRectangle( wxDC& dc,
8144 const wxString& value,
8145 const wxRect& rect,
8146 int horizAlign,
8147 int vertAlign,
8148 int textOrientation )
8149 {
8150 wxArrayString lines;
8151
8152 StringToLines( value, lines );
8153
8154 DrawTextRectangle(dc, lines, rect, horizAlign, vertAlign, textOrientation);
8155 }
8156
8157 void wxGrid::DrawTextRectangle(wxDC& dc,
8158 const wxArrayString& lines,
8159 const wxRect& rect,
8160 int horizAlign,
8161 int vertAlign,
8162 int textOrientation)
8163 {
8164 if ( lines.empty() )
8165 return;
8166
8167 wxDCClipper clip(dc, rect);
8168
8169 long textWidth,
8170 textHeight;
8171
8172 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8173 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &textWidth, &textHeight );
8174 else
8175 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &textHeight, &textWidth );
8176
8177 int x = 0,
8178 y = 0;
8179 switch ( vertAlign )
8180 {
8181 case wxALIGN_BOTTOM:
8182 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8183 y = rect.y + (rect.height - textHeight - 1);
8184 else
8185 x = rect.x + rect.width - textWidth;
8186 break;
8187
8188 case wxALIGN_CENTRE:
8189 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8190 y = rect.y + ((rect.height - textHeight) / 2);
8191 else
8192 x = rect.x + ((rect.width - textWidth) / 2);
8193 break;
8194
8195 case wxALIGN_TOP:
8196 default:
8197 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8198 y = rect.y + 1;
8199 else
8200 x = rect.x + 1;
8201 break;
8202 }
8203
8204 // Align each line of a multi-line label
8205 size_t nLines = lines.GetCount();
8206 for ( size_t l = 0; l < nLines; l++ )
8207 {
8208 const wxString& line = lines[l];
8209
8210 if ( line.empty() )
8211 {
8212 *(textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL ? &y : &x) += dc.GetCharHeight();
8213 continue;
8214 }
8215
8216 wxCoord lineWidth = 0,
8217 lineHeight = 0;
8218 dc.GetTextExtent(line, &lineWidth, &lineHeight);
8219
8220 switch ( horizAlign )
8221 {
8222 case wxALIGN_RIGHT:
8223 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8224 x = rect.x + (rect.width - lineWidth - 1);
8225 else
8226 y = rect.y + lineWidth + 1;
8227 break;
8228
8229 case wxALIGN_CENTRE:
8230 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8231 x = rect.x + ((rect.width - lineWidth) / 2);
8232 else
8233 y = rect.y + rect.height - ((rect.height - lineWidth) / 2);
8234 break;
8235
8236 case wxALIGN_LEFT:
8237 default:
8238 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8239 x = rect.x + 1;
8240 else
8241 y = rect.y + rect.height - 1;
8242 break;
8243 }
8244
8245 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8246 {
8247 dc.DrawText( line, x, y );
8248 y += lineHeight;
8249 }
8250 else
8251 {
8252 dc.DrawRotatedText( line, x, y, 90.0 );
8253 x += lineHeight;
8254 }
8255 }
8256 }
8257
8258 // Split multi-line text up into an array of strings.
8259 // Any existing contents of the string array are preserved.
8260 //
8261 // TODO: refactor wxTextFile::Read() and reuse the same code from here
8262 void wxGrid::StringToLines( const wxString& value, wxArrayString& lines ) const
8263 {
8264 int startPos = 0;
8265 int pos;
8266 wxString eol = wxTextFile::GetEOL( wxTextFileType_Unix );
8267 wxString tVal = wxTextFile::Translate( value, wxTextFileType_Unix );
8268
8269 while ( startPos < (int)tVal.length() )
8270 {
8271 pos = tVal.Mid(startPos).Find( eol );
8272 if ( pos < 0 )
8273 {
8274 break;
8275 }
8276 else if ( pos == 0 )
8277 {
8278 lines.Add( wxEmptyString );
8279 }
8280 else
8281 {
8282 lines.Add( tVal.Mid(startPos, pos) );
8283 }
8284
8285 startPos += pos + 1;
8286 }
8287
8288 if ( startPos < (int)tVal.length() )
8289 {
8290 lines.Add( tVal.Mid( startPos ) );
8291 }
8292 }
8293
8294 void wxGrid::GetTextBoxSize( const wxDC& dc,
8295 const wxArrayString& lines,
8296 long *width, long *height ) const
8297 {
8298 wxCoord w = 0;
8299 wxCoord h = 0;
8300 wxCoord lineW = 0, lineH = 0;
8301
8302 size_t i;
8303 for ( i = 0; i < lines.GetCount(); i++ )
8304 {
8305 dc.GetTextExtent( lines[i], &lineW, &lineH );
8306 w = wxMax( w, lineW );
8307 h += lineH;
8308 }
8309
8310 *width = w;
8311 *height = h;
8312 }
8313
8314 //
8315 // ------ Batch processing.
8316 //
8317 void wxGrid::EndBatch()
8318 {
8319 if ( m_batchCount > 0 )
8320 {
8321 m_batchCount--;
8322 if ( !m_batchCount )
8323 {
8324 CalcDimensions();
8325 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
8326 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
8327 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh();
8328 m_gridWin->Refresh();
8329 }
8330 }
8331 }
8332
8333 // Use this, rather than wxWindow::Refresh(), to force an immediate
8334 // repainting of the grid. Has no effect if you are already inside a
8335 // BeginBatch / EndBatch block.
8336 //
8337 void wxGrid::ForceRefresh()
8338 {
8339 BeginBatch();
8340 EndBatch();
8341 }
8342
8343 bool wxGrid::Enable(bool enable)
8344 {
8345 if ( !wxScrolledWindow::Enable(enable) )
8346 return false;
8347
8348 // redraw in the new state
8349 m_gridWin->Refresh();
8350
8351 return true;
8352 }
8353
8354 //
8355 // ------ Edit control functions
8356 //
8357
8358 void wxGrid::EnableEditing( bool edit )
8359 {
8360 if ( edit != m_editable )
8361 {
8362 if (!edit)
8363 EnableCellEditControl(edit);
8364 m_editable = edit;
8365 }
8366 }
8367
8368 void wxGrid::EnableCellEditControl( bool enable )
8369 {
8370 if (! m_editable)
8371 return;
8372
8373 if ( enable != m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
8374 {
8375 if ( enable )
8376 {
8377 if ( SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_SHOWN) == -1 )
8378 return;
8379
8380 // this should be checked by the caller!
8381 wxASSERT_MSG( CanEnableCellControl(), _T("can't enable editing for this cell!") );
8382
8383 // do it before ShowCellEditControl()
8384 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = enable;
8385
8386 ShowCellEditControl();
8387 }
8388 else
8389 {
8390 //FIXME:add veto support
8391 SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_HIDDEN);
8392
8393 HideCellEditControl();
8394 SaveEditControlValue();
8395
8396 // do it after HideCellEditControl()
8397 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = enable;
8398 }
8399 }
8400 }
8401
8402 bool wxGrid::IsCurrentCellReadOnly() const
8403 {
8404 // const_cast
8405 wxGridCellAttr* attr = ((wxGrid *)this)->GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
8406 bool readonly = attr->IsReadOnly();
8407 attr->DecRef();
8408
8409 return readonly;
8410 }
8411
8412 bool wxGrid::CanEnableCellControl() const
8413 {
8414 return m_editable && (m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords) &&
8415 !IsCurrentCellReadOnly();
8416 }
8417
8418 bool wxGrid::IsCellEditControlEnabled() const
8419 {
8420 // the cell edit control might be disable for all cells or just for the
8421 // current one if it's read only
8422 return m_cellEditCtrlEnabled ? !IsCurrentCellReadOnly() : false;
8423 }
8424
8425 bool wxGrid::IsCellEditControlShown() const
8426 {
8427 bool isShown = false;
8428
8429 if ( m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
8430 {
8431 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8432 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8433 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8434 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor((wxGrid*) this, row, col);
8435 attr->DecRef();
8436
8437 if ( editor )
8438 {
8439 if ( editor->IsCreated() )
8440 {
8441 isShown = editor->GetControl()->IsShown();
8442 }
8443
8444 editor->DecRef();
8445 }
8446 }
8447
8448 return isShown;
8449 }
8450
8451 void wxGrid::ShowCellEditControl()
8452 {
8453 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8454 {
8455 if ( !IsVisible( m_currentCellCoords, false ) )
8456 {
8457 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = false;
8458 return;
8459 }
8460 else
8461 {
8462 wxRect rect = CellToRect( m_currentCellCoords );
8463 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8464 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8465
8466 // if this is part of a multicell, find owner (topleft)
8467 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
8468 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8469 if ( cell_rows <= 0 || cell_cols <= 0 )
8470 {
8471 row += cell_rows;
8472 col += cell_cols;
8473 m_currentCellCoords.SetRow( row );
8474 m_currentCellCoords.SetCol( col );
8475 }
8476
8477 // erase the highlight and the cell contents because the editor
8478 // might not cover the entire cell
8479 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
8480 PrepareDC( dc );
8481 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8482 dc.SetBrush(wxBrush(attr->GetBackgroundColour()));
8483 dc.SetPen(*wxTRANSPARENT_PEN);
8484 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
8485
8486 // convert to scrolled coords
8487 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
8488
8489 int nXMove = 0;
8490 if (rect.x < 0)
8491 nXMove = rect.x;
8492
8493 // cell is shifted by one pixel
8494 // However, don't allow x or y to become negative
8495 // since the SetSize() method interprets that as
8496 // "don't change."
8497 if (rect.x > 0)
8498 rect.x--;
8499 if (rect.y > 0)
8500 rect.y--;
8501
8502 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8503 if ( !editor->IsCreated() )
8504 {
8505 editor->Create(m_gridWin, wxID_ANY,
8506 new wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler(this, editor));
8507
8508 wxGridEditorCreatedEvent evt(GetId(),
8509 wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_CREATED,
8510 this,
8511 row,
8512 col,
8513 editor->GetControl());
8514 GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(evt);
8515 }
8516
8517 // resize editor to overflow into righthand cells if allowed
8518 int maxWidth = rect.width;
8519 wxString value = GetCellValue(row, col);
8520 if ( (value != wxEmptyString) && (attr->GetOverflow()) )
8521 {
8522 int y;
8523 GetTextExtent(value, &maxWidth, &y, NULL, NULL, &attr->GetFont());
8524 if (maxWidth < rect.width)
8525 maxWidth = rect.width;
8526 }
8527
8528 int client_right = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
8529 if (rect.x + maxWidth > client_right)
8530 maxWidth = client_right - rect.x;
8531
8532 if ((maxWidth > rect.width) && (col < m_numCols) && m_table)
8533 {
8534 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8535 // may have changed earlier
8536 for (int i = col + cell_cols; i < m_numCols; i++)
8537 {
8538 int c_rows, c_cols;
8539 GetCellSize( row, i, &c_rows, &c_cols );
8540
8541 // looks weird going over a multicell
8542 if (m_table->IsEmptyCell( row, i ) &&
8543 (rect.width < maxWidth) && (c_rows == 1))
8544 {
8545 rect.width += GetColWidth( i );
8546 }
8547 else
8548 break;
8549 }
8550
8551 if (rect.GetRight() > client_right)
8552 rect.SetRight( client_right - 1 );
8553 }
8554
8555 editor->SetCellAttr( attr );
8556 editor->SetSize( rect );
8557 if (nXMove != 0)
8558 editor->GetControl()->Move(
8559 editor->GetControl()->GetPosition().x + nXMove,
8560 editor->GetControl()->GetPosition().y );
8561 editor->Show( true, attr );
8562
8563 // recalc dimensions in case we need to
8564 // expand the scrolled window to account for editor
8565 CalcDimensions();
8566
8567 editor->BeginEdit(row, col, this);
8568 editor->SetCellAttr(NULL);
8569
8570 editor->DecRef();
8571 attr->DecRef();
8572 }
8573 }
8574 }
8575
8576 void wxGrid::HideCellEditControl()
8577 {
8578 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8579 {
8580 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8581 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8582
8583 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8584 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8585 const bool editorHadFocus = editor->GetControl()->HasFocus();
8586 editor->Show( false );
8587 editor->DecRef();
8588 attr->DecRef();
8589
8590 // return the focus to the grid itself if the editor had it
8591 //
8592 // note that we must not do this unconditionally to avoid stealing
8593 // focus from the window which just received it if we are hiding the
8594 // editor precisely because we lost focus
8595 if ( editorHadFocus )
8596 m_gridWin->SetFocus();
8597
8598 // refresh whole row to the right
8599 wxRect rect( CellToRect(row, col) );
8600 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
8601 rect.width = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth() - rect.x;
8602
8603 #ifdef __WXMAC__
8604 // ensure that the pixels under the focus ring get refreshed as well
8605 rect.Inflate(10, 10);
8606 #endif
8607
8608 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
8609 }
8610 }
8611
8612 void wxGrid::SaveEditControlValue()
8613 {
8614 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8615 {
8616 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8617 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8618
8619 wxString oldval = GetCellValue(row, col);
8620
8621 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8622 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8623 bool changed = editor->EndEdit(row, col, this);
8624
8625 editor->DecRef();
8626 attr->DecRef();
8627
8628 if (changed)
8629 {
8630 if ( SendEvent(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE) == -1 )
8631 {
8632 // Event has been vetoed, set the data back.
8633 SetCellValue(row, col, oldval);
8634 }
8635 }
8636 }
8637 }
8638
8639 //
8640 // ------ Grid location functions
8641 // Note that all of these functions work with the logical coordinates of
8642 // grid cells and labels so you will need to convert from device
8643 // coordinates for mouse events etc.
8644 //
8645
8646 wxGridCellCoords wxGrid::XYToCell(int x, int y) const
8647 {
8648 int row = YToRow(y);
8649 int col = XToCol(x);
8650
8651 return row == -1 || col == -1 ? wxGridNoCellCoords
8652 : wxGridCellCoords(row, col);
8653 }
8654
8655 // compute row or column from some (unscrolled) coordinate value, using either
8656 // m_defaultRowHeight/m_defaultColWidth or binary search on array of
8657 // m_rowBottoms/m_colRights to do it quickly (linear search shouldn't be used
8658 // for large grids)
8659 int
8660 wxGrid::PosToLine(int coord,
8661 bool clipToMinMax,
8662 const wxGridOperations& oper) const
8663 {
8664 const int numLines = oper.GetNumberOfLines(this);
8665
8666 if ( coord < 0 )
8667 return clipToMinMax && numLines > 0 ? oper.GetLineAt(this, 0) : -1;
8668
8669 const int defaultLineSize = oper.GetDefaultLineSize(this);
8670 wxCHECK_MSG( defaultLineSize, -1, "can't have 0 default line size" );
8671
8672 int maxPos = coord / defaultLineSize,
8673 minPos = 0;
8674
8675 // check for the simplest case: if we have no explicit line sizes
8676 // configured, then we already know the line this position falls in
8677 const wxArrayInt& lineEnds = oper.GetLineEnds(this);
8678 if ( lineEnds.empty() )
8679 {
8680 if ( maxPos < numLines )
8681 return maxPos;
8682
8683 return clipToMinMax ? numLines - 1 : -1;
8684 }
8685
8686
8687 // adjust maxPos before starting the binary search
8688 if ( maxPos >= numLines )
8689 {
8690 maxPos = numLines - 1;
8691 }
8692 else
8693 {
8694 if ( coord >= lineEnds[oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos)])
8695 {
8696 minPos = maxPos;
8697 const int minDist = oper.GetMinimalAcceptableLineSize(this);
8698 if ( minDist )
8699 maxPos = coord / minDist;
8700 else
8701 maxPos = numLines - 1;
8702 }
8703
8704 if ( maxPos >= numLines )
8705 maxPos = numLines - 1;
8706 }
8707
8708 // check if the position is beyond the last column
8709 const int lineAtMaxPos = oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos);
8710 if ( coord >= lineEnds[lineAtMaxPos] )
8711 return clipToMinMax ? lineAtMaxPos : -1;
8712
8713 // or before the first one
8714 const int lineAt0 = oper.GetLineAt(this, 0);
8715 if ( coord < lineEnds[lineAt0] )
8716 return lineAt0;
8717
8718
8719 // finally do perform the binary search
8720 while ( minPos < maxPos )
8721 {
8722 wxCHECK_MSG( lineEnds[oper.GetLineAt(this, minPos)] <= coord &&
8723 coord < lineEnds[oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos)],
8724 -1,
8725 "wxGrid: internal error in PosToLine()" );
8726
8727 if ( coord >= lineEnds[oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos - 1)] )
8728 return oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos);
8729 else
8730 maxPos--;
8731
8732 const int median = minPos + (maxPos - minPos + 1) / 2;
8733 if ( coord < lineEnds[oper.GetLineAt(this, median)] )
8734 maxPos = median;
8735 else
8736 minPos = median;
8737 }
8738
8739 return oper.GetLineAt(this, maxPos);
8740 }
8741
8742 int wxGrid::YToRow(int y, bool clipToMinMax) const
8743 {
8744 return PosToLine(y, clipToMinMax, wxGridRowOperations());
8745 }
8746
8747 int wxGrid::XToCol(int x, bool clipToMinMax) const
8748 {
8749 return PosToLine(x, clipToMinMax, wxGridColumnOperations());
8750 }
8751
8752 // return the row number that that the y coord is near the edge of, or -1 if
8753 // not near an edge.
8754 //
8755 // coords can only possibly be near an edge if
8756 // (a) the row/column is large enough to still allow for an "inner" area
8757 // that is _not_ near the edge (i.e., if the height/width is smaller
8758 // than WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE, coords are _never_ considered to be
8759 // near the edge).
8760 // and
8761 // (b) resizing rows/columns (the thing for which edge detection is
8762 // relevant at all) is enabled.
8763 //
8764 int wxGrid::PosToEdgeOfLine(int pos, const wxGridOperations& oper) const
8765 {
8766 if ( !oper.CanResizeLines(this) )
8767 return -1;
8768
8769 const int line = oper.PosToLine(this, pos, true);
8770
8771 if ( oper.GetLineSize(this, line) > WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8772 {
8773 // We know that we are in this line, test whether we are close enough
8774 // to start or end border, respectively.
8775 if ( abs(oper.GetLineEndPos(this, line) - pos) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8776 return line;
8777 else if ( line > 0 &&
8778 pos - oper.GetLineStartPos(this,
8779 line) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8780 return line - 1;
8781 }
8782
8783 return -1;
8784 }
8785
8786 int wxGrid::YToEdgeOfRow(int y) const
8787 {
8788 return PosToEdgeOfLine(y, wxGridRowOperations());
8789 }
8790
8791 int wxGrid::XToEdgeOfCol(int x) const
8792 {
8793 return PosToEdgeOfLine(x, wxGridColumnOperations());
8794 }
8795
8796 wxRect wxGrid::CellToRect( int row, int col ) const
8797 {
8798 wxRect rect( -1, -1, -1, -1 );
8799
8800 if ( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows &&
8801 col >= 0 && col < m_numCols )
8802 {
8803 int i, cell_rows, cell_cols;
8804 rect.width = rect.height = 0;
8805 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8806 // if negative then find multicell owner
8807 if (cell_rows < 0)
8808 row += cell_rows;
8809 if (cell_cols < 0)
8810 col += cell_cols;
8811 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8812
8813 rect.x = GetColLeft(col);
8814 rect.y = GetRowTop(row);
8815 for (i=col; i < col + cell_cols; i++)
8816 rect.width += GetColWidth(i);
8817 for (i=row; i < row + cell_rows; i++)
8818 rect.height += GetRowHeight(i);
8819 }
8820
8821 // if grid lines are enabled, then the area of the cell is a bit smaller
8822 if (m_gridLinesEnabled)
8823 {
8824 rect.width -= 1;
8825 rect.height -= 1;
8826 }
8827
8828 return rect;
8829 }
8830
8831 bool wxGrid::IsVisible( int row, int col, bool wholeCellVisible ) const
8832 {
8833 // get the cell rectangle in logical coords
8834 //
8835 wxRect r( CellToRect( row, col ) );
8836
8837 // convert to device coords
8838 //
8839 int left, top, right, bottom;
8840 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
8841 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
8842
8843 // check against the client area of the grid window
8844 int cw, ch;
8845 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
8846
8847 if ( wholeCellVisible )
8848 {
8849 // is the cell wholly visible ?
8850 return ( left >= 0 && right <= cw &&
8851 top >= 0 && bottom <= ch );
8852 }
8853 else
8854 {
8855 // is the cell partly visible ?
8856 //
8857 return ( ((left >= 0 && left < cw) || (right > 0 && right <= cw)) &&
8858 ((top >= 0 && top < ch) || (bottom > 0 && bottom <= ch)) );
8859 }
8860 }
8861
8862 // make the specified cell location visible by doing a minimal amount
8863 // of scrolling
8864 //
8865 void wxGrid::MakeCellVisible( int row, int col )
8866 {
8867 int i;
8868 int xpos = -1, ypos = -1;
8869
8870 if ( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows &&
8871 col >= 0 && col < m_numCols )
8872 {
8873 // get the cell rectangle in logical coords
8874 wxRect r( CellToRect( row, col ) );
8875
8876 // convert to device coords
8877 int left, top, right, bottom;
8878 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
8879 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
8880
8881 int cw, ch;
8882 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
8883
8884 if ( top < 0 )
8885 {
8886 ypos = r.GetTop();
8887 }
8888 else if ( bottom > ch )
8889 {
8890 int h = r.GetHeight();
8891 ypos = r.GetTop();
8892 for ( i = row - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
8893 {
8894 int rowHeight = GetRowHeight(i);
8895 if ( h + rowHeight > ch )
8896 break;
8897
8898 h += rowHeight;
8899 ypos -= rowHeight;
8900 }
8901
8902 // we divide it later by GRID_SCROLL_LINE, make sure that we don't
8903 // have rounding errors (this is important, because if we do,
8904 // we might not scroll at all and some cells won't be redrawn)
8905 //
8906 // Sometimes GRID_SCROLL_LINE / 2 is not enough,
8907 // so just add a full scroll unit...
8908 ypos += m_scrollLineY;
8909 }
8910
8911 // special handling for wide cells - show always left part of the cell!
8912 // Otherwise, e.g. when stepping from row to row, it would jump between
8913 // left and right part of the cell on every step!
8914 // if ( left < 0 )
8915 if ( left < 0 || (right - left) >= cw )
8916 {
8917 xpos = r.GetLeft();
8918 }
8919 else if ( right > cw )
8920 {
8921 // position the view so that the cell is on the right
8922 int x0, y0;
8923 CalcUnscrolledPosition(0, 0, &x0, &y0);
8924 xpos = x0 + (right - cw);
8925
8926 // see comment for ypos above
8927 xpos += m_scrollLineX;
8928 }
8929
8930 if ( xpos != -1 || ypos != -1 )
8931 {
8932 if ( xpos != -1 )
8933 xpos /= m_scrollLineX;
8934 if ( ypos != -1 )
8935 ypos /= m_scrollLineY;
8936 Scroll( xpos, ypos );
8937 AdjustScrollbars();
8938 }
8939 }
8940 }
8941
8942 //
8943 // ------ Grid cursor movement functions
8944 //
8945
8946 bool
8947 wxGrid::DoMoveCursor(bool expandSelection,
8948 const wxGridDirectionOperations& diroper)
8949 {
8950 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
8951 return false;
8952
8953 if ( expandSelection )
8954 {
8955 wxGridCellCoords coords = m_selectedBlockCorner;
8956 if ( coords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
8957 coords = m_currentCellCoords;
8958
8959 if ( diroper.IsAtBoundary(coords) )
8960 return false;
8961
8962 diroper.Advance(coords);
8963
8964 UpdateBlockBeingSelected(m_currentCellCoords, coords);
8965 }
8966 else // don't expand selection
8967 {
8968 ClearSelection();
8969
8970 if ( diroper.IsAtBoundary(m_currentCellCoords) )
8971 return false;
8972
8973 wxGridCellCoords coords = m_currentCellCoords;
8974 diroper.Advance(coords);
8975
8976 GoToCell(coords);
8977 }
8978
8979 return true;
8980 }
8981
8982 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorUp(bool expandSelection)
8983 {
8984 return DoMoveCursor(expandSelection,
8985 wxGridBackwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations()));
8986 }
8987
8988 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorDown(bool expandSelection)
8989 {
8990 return DoMoveCursor(expandSelection,
8991 wxGridForwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations()));
8992 }
8993
8994 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorLeft(bool expandSelection)
8995 {
8996 return DoMoveCursor(expandSelection,
8997 wxGridBackwardOperations(this, wxGridColumnOperations()));
8998 }
8999
9000 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorRight(bool expandSelection)
9001 {
9002 return DoMoveCursor(expandSelection,
9003 wxGridForwardOperations(this, wxGridColumnOperations()));
9004 }
9005
9006 bool wxGrid::DoMoveCursorByPage(const wxGridDirectionOperations& diroper)
9007 {
9008 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
9009 return false;
9010
9011 if ( diroper.IsAtBoundary(m_currentCellCoords) )
9012 return false;
9013
9014 const int oldRow = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9015 int newRow = diroper.MoveByPixelDistance(oldRow, m_gridWin->GetClientSize().y);
9016 if ( newRow == oldRow )
9017 {
9018 wxGridCellCoords coords(m_currentCellCoords);
9019 diroper.Advance(coords);
9020 newRow = coords.GetRow();
9021 }
9022
9023 GoToCell(newRow, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol());
9024
9025 return true;
9026 }
9027
9028 bool wxGrid::MovePageUp()
9029 {
9030 return DoMoveCursorByPage(
9031 wxGridBackwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations()));
9032 }
9033
9034 bool wxGrid::MovePageDown()
9035 {
9036 return DoMoveCursorByPage(
9037 wxGridForwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations()));
9038 }
9039
9040 // helper of DoMoveCursorByBlock(): advance the cell coordinates using diroper
9041 // until we find a non-empty cell or reach the grid end
9042 void
9043 wxGrid::AdvanceToNextNonEmpty(wxGridCellCoords& coords,
9044 const wxGridDirectionOperations& diroper)
9045 {
9046 while ( !diroper.IsAtBoundary(coords) )
9047 {
9048 diroper.Advance(coords);
9049 if ( !m_table->IsEmpty(coords) )
9050 break;
9051 }
9052 }
9053
9054 bool
9055 wxGrid::DoMoveCursorByBlock(bool expandSelection,
9056 const wxGridDirectionOperations& diroper)
9057 {
9058 if ( !m_table || m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
9059 return false;
9060
9061 if ( diroper.IsAtBoundary(m_currentCellCoords) )
9062 return false;
9063
9064 wxGridCellCoords coords(m_currentCellCoords);
9065 if ( m_table->IsEmpty(coords) )
9066 {
9067 // we are in an empty cell: find the next block of non-empty cells
9068 AdvanceToNextNonEmpty(coords, diroper);
9069 }
9070 else // current cell is not empty
9071 {
9072 diroper.Advance(coords);
9073 if ( m_table->IsEmpty(coords) )
9074 {
9075 // we started at the end of a block, find the next one
9076 AdvanceToNextNonEmpty(coords, diroper);
9077 }
9078 else // we're in a middle of a block
9079 {
9080 // go to the end of it, i.e. find the last cell before the next
9081 // empty one
9082 while ( !diroper.IsAtBoundary(coords) )
9083 {
9084 wxGridCellCoords coordsNext(coords);
9085 diroper.Advance(coordsNext);
9086 if ( m_table->IsEmpty(coordsNext) )
9087 break;
9088
9089 coords = coordsNext;
9090 }
9091 }
9092 }
9093
9094 if ( expandSelection )
9095 {
9096 UpdateBlockBeingSelected(m_currentCellCoords, coords);
9097 }
9098 else
9099 {
9100 ClearSelection();
9101 GoToCell(coords);
9102 }
9103
9104 return true;
9105 }
9106
9107 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorUpBlock(bool expandSelection)
9108 {
9109 return DoMoveCursorByBlock(
9110 expandSelection,
9111 wxGridBackwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations())
9112 );
9113 }
9114
9115 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorDownBlock( bool expandSelection )
9116 {
9117 return DoMoveCursorByBlock(
9118 expandSelection,
9119 wxGridForwardOperations(this, wxGridRowOperations())
9120 );
9121 }
9122
9123 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorLeftBlock( bool expandSelection )
9124 {
9125 return DoMoveCursorByBlock(
9126 expandSelection,
9127 wxGridBackwardOperations(this, wxGridColumnOperations())
9128 );
9129 }
9130
9131 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorRightBlock( bool expandSelection )
9132 {
9133 return DoMoveCursorByBlock(
9134 expandSelection,
9135 wxGridForwardOperations(this, wxGridColumnOperations())
9136 );
9137 }
9138
9139 //
9140 // ------ Label values and formatting
9141 //
9142
9143 void wxGrid::GetRowLabelAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9144 {
9145 if ( horiz )
9146 *horiz = m_rowLabelHorizAlign;
9147 if ( vert )
9148 *vert = m_rowLabelVertAlign;
9149 }
9150
9151 void wxGrid::GetColLabelAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9152 {
9153 if ( horiz )
9154 *horiz = m_colLabelHorizAlign;
9155 if ( vert )
9156 *vert = m_colLabelVertAlign;
9157 }
9158
9159 int wxGrid::GetColLabelTextOrientation() const
9160 {
9161 return m_colLabelTextOrientation;
9162 }
9163
9164 wxString wxGrid::GetRowLabelValue( int row ) const
9165 {
9166 if ( m_table )
9167 {
9168 return m_table->GetRowLabelValue( row );
9169 }
9170 else
9171 {
9172 wxString s;
9173 s << row;
9174 return s;
9175 }
9176 }
9177
9178 wxString wxGrid::GetColLabelValue( int col ) const
9179 {
9180 if ( m_table )
9181 {
9182 return m_table->GetColLabelValue( col );
9183 }
9184 else
9185 {
9186 wxString s;
9187 s << col;
9188 return s;
9189 }
9190 }
9191
9192 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelSize( int width )
9193 {
9194 wxASSERT( width >= 0 || width == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE );
9195
9196 if ( width == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE )
9197 {
9198 width = CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGRID_ROW);
9199 }
9200
9201 if ( width != m_rowLabelWidth )
9202 {
9203 if ( width == 0 )
9204 {
9205 m_rowLabelWin->Show( false );
9206 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( false );
9207 }
9208 else if ( m_rowLabelWidth == 0 )
9209 {
9210 m_rowLabelWin->Show( true );
9211 if ( m_colLabelHeight > 0 )
9212 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( true );
9213 }
9214
9215 m_rowLabelWidth = width;
9216 CalcWindowSizes();
9217 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh( true );
9218 }
9219 }
9220
9221 void wxGrid::SetColLabelSize( int height )
9222 {
9223 wxASSERT( height >=0 || height == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE );
9224
9225 if ( height == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE )
9226 {
9227 height = CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGRID_COLUMN);
9228 }
9229
9230 if ( height != m_colLabelHeight )
9231 {
9232 if ( height == 0 )
9233 {
9234 m_colLabelWin->Show( false );
9235 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( false );
9236 }
9237 else if ( m_colLabelHeight == 0 )
9238 {
9239 m_colLabelWin->Show( true );
9240 if ( m_rowLabelWidth > 0 )
9241 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( true );
9242 }
9243
9244 m_colLabelHeight = height;
9245 CalcWindowSizes();
9246 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh( true );
9247 }
9248 }
9249
9250 void wxGrid::SetLabelBackgroundColour( const wxColour& colour )
9251 {
9252 if ( m_labelBackgroundColour != colour )
9253 {
9254 m_labelBackgroundColour = colour;
9255 m_rowLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9256 m_colLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9257 m_cornerLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9258
9259 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9260 {
9261 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9262 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9263 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh();
9264 }
9265 }
9266 }
9267
9268 void wxGrid::SetLabelTextColour( const wxColour& colour )
9269 {
9270 if ( m_labelTextColour != colour )
9271 {
9272 m_labelTextColour = colour;
9273 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9274 {
9275 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9276 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9277 }
9278 }
9279 }
9280
9281 void wxGrid::SetLabelFont( const wxFont& font )
9282 {
9283 m_labelFont = font;
9284 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9285 {
9286 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9287 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9288 }
9289 }
9290
9291 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9292 {
9293 // allow old (incorrect) defs to be used
9294 switch ( horiz )
9295 {
9296 case wxLEFT: horiz = wxALIGN_LEFT; break;
9297 case wxRIGHT: horiz = wxALIGN_RIGHT; break;
9298 case wxCENTRE: horiz = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9299 }
9300
9301 switch ( vert )
9302 {
9303 case wxTOP: vert = wxALIGN_TOP; break;
9304 case wxBOTTOM: vert = wxALIGN_BOTTOM; break;
9305 case wxCENTRE: vert = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9306 }
9307
9308 if ( horiz == wxALIGN_LEFT || horiz == wxALIGN_CENTRE || horiz == wxALIGN_RIGHT )
9309 {
9310 m_rowLabelHorizAlign = horiz;
9311 }
9312
9313 if ( vert == wxALIGN_TOP || vert == wxALIGN_CENTRE || vert == wxALIGN_BOTTOM )
9314 {
9315 m_rowLabelVertAlign = vert;
9316 }
9317
9318 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9319 {
9320 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9321 }
9322 }
9323
9324 void wxGrid::SetColLabelAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9325 {
9326 // allow old (incorrect) defs to be used
9327 switch ( horiz )
9328 {
9329 case wxLEFT: horiz = wxALIGN_LEFT; break;
9330 case wxRIGHT: horiz = wxALIGN_RIGHT; break;
9331 case wxCENTRE: horiz = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9332 }
9333
9334 switch ( vert )
9335 {
9336 case wxTOP: vert = wxALIGN_TOP; break;
9337 case wxBOTTOM: vert = wxALIGN_BOTTOM; break;
9338 case wxCENTRE: vert = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9339 }
9340
9341 if ( horiz == wxALIGN_LEFT || horiz == wxALIGN_CENTRE || horiz == wxALIGN_RIGHT )
9342 {
9343 m_colLabelHorizAlign = horiz;
9344 }
9345
9346 if ( vert == wxALIGN_TOP || vert == wxALIGN_CENTRE || vert == wxALIGN_BOTTOM )
9347 {
9348 m_colLabelVertAlign = vert;
9349 }
9350
9351 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9352 {
9353 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9354 }
9355 }
9356
9357 // Note: under MSW, the default column label font must be changed because it
9358 // does not support vertical printing
9359 //
9360 // Example: wxFont font(9, wxSWISS, wxNORMAL, wxBOLD);
9361 // pGrid->SetLabelFont(font);
9362 // pGrid->SetColLabelTextOrientation(wxVERTICAL);
9363 //
9364 void wxGrid::SetColLabelTextOrientation( int textOrientation )
9365 {
9366 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL || textOrientation == wxVERTICAL )
9367 m_colLabelTextOrientation = textOrientation;
9368
9369 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9370 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9371 }
9372
9373 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelValue( int row, const wxString& s )
9374 {
9375 if ( m_table )
9376 {
9377 m_table->SetRowLabelValue( row, s );
9378 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9379 {
9380 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, 0 );
9381 if ( rect.height > 0 )
9382 {
9383 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y);
9384 rect.x = 0;
9385 rect.width = m_rowLabelWidth;
9386 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
9387 }
9388 }
9389 }
9390 }
9391
9392 void wxGrid::SetColLabelValue( int col, const wxString& s )
9393 {
9394 if ( m_table )
9395 {
9396 m_table->SetColLabelValue( col, s );
9397 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9398 {
9399 wxRect rect = CellToRect( 0, col );
9400 if ( rect.width > 0 )
9401 {
9402 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &rect.y);
9403 rect.y = 0;
9404 rect.height = m_colLabelHeight;
9405 m_colLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
9406 }
9407 }
9408 }
9409 }
9410
9411 void wxGrid::SetGridLineColour( const wxColour& colour )
9412 {
9413 if ( m_gridLineColour != colour )
9414 {
9415 m_gridLineColour = colour;
9416
9417 if ( GridLinesEnabled() )
9418 RedrawGridLines();
9419 }
9420 }
9421
9422 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightColour( const wxColour& colour )
9423 {
9424 if ( m_cellHighlightColour != colour )
9425 {
9426 m_cellHighlightColour = colour;
9427
9428 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
9429 PrepareDC( dc );
9430 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
9431 DrawCellHighlight(dc, attr);
9432 attr->DecRef();
9433 }
9434 }
9435
9436 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightPenWidth(int width)
9437 {
9438 if (m_cellHighlightPenWidth != width)
9439 {
9440 m_cellHighlightPenWidth = width;
9441
9442 // Just redrawing the cell highlight is not enough since that won't
9443 // make any visible change if the the thickness is getting smaller.
9444 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9445 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9446 if ( row == -1 || col == -1 || GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
9447 return;
9448
9449 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
9450 m_gridWin->Refresh(true, &rect);
9451 }
9452 }
9453
9454 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightROPenWidth(int width)
9455 {
9456 if (m_cellHighlightROPenWidth != width)
9457 {
9458 m_cellHighlightROPenWidth = width;
9459
9460 // Just redrawing the cell highlight is not enough since that won't
9461 // make any visible change if the the thickness is getting smaller.
9462 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9463 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9464 if ( row == -1 || col == -1 ||
9465 GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
9466 return;
9467
9468 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
9469 m_gridWin->Refresh(true, &rect);
9470 }
9471 }
9472
9473 void wxGrid::RedrawGridLines()
9474 {
9475 // the lines will be redrawn when the window is thawn
9476 if ( GetBatchCount() )
9477 return;
9478
9479 if ( GridLinesEnabled() )
9480 {
9481 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
9482 PrepareDC( dc );
9483 DrawAllGridLines( dc, wxRegion() );
9484 }
9485 else // remove the grid lines
9486 {
9487 m_gridWin->Refresh();
9488 }
9489 }
9490
9491 void wxGrid::EnableGridLines( bool enable )
9492 {
9493 if ( enable != m_gridLinesEnabled )
9494 {
9495 m_gridLinesEnabled = enable;
9496
9497 RedrawGridLines();
9498 }
9499 }
9500
9501 void wxGrid::DoClipGridLines(bool& var, bool clip)
9502 {
9503 if ( clip != var )
9504 {
9505 var = clip;
9506
9507 if ( GridLinesEnabled() )
9508 RedrawGridLines();
9509 }
9510 }
9511
9512 int wxGrid::GetDefaultRowSize() const
9513 {
9514 return m_defaultRowHeight;
9515 }
9516
9517 int wxGrid::GetRowSize( int row ) const
9518 {
9519 wxCHECK_MSG( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows, 0, _T("invalid row index") );
9520
9521 return GetRowHeight(row);
9522 }
9523
9524 int wxGrid::GetDefaultColSize() const
9525 {
9526 return m_defaultColWidth;
9527 }
9528
9529 int wxGrid::GetColSize( int col ) const
9530 {
9531 wxCHECK_MSG( col >= 0 && col < m_numCols, 0, _T("invalid column index") );
9532
9533 return GetColWidth(col);
9534 }
9535
9536 // ============================================================================
9537 // access to the grid attributes: each of them has a default value in the grid
9538 // itself and may be overidden on a per-cell basis
9539 // ============================================================================
9540
9541 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9542 // setting default attributes
9543 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9544
9545 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellBackgroundColour( const wxColour& col )
9546 {
9547 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(col);
9548 #ifdef __WXGTK__
9549 m_gridWin->SetBackgroundColour(col);
9550 #endif
9551 }
9552
9553 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellTextColour( const wxColour& col )
9554 {
9555 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(col);
9556 }
9557
9558 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9559 {
9560 m_defaultCellAttr->SetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9561 }
9562
9563 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellOverflow( bool allow )
9564 {
9565 m_defaultCellAttr->SetOverflow(allow);
9566 }
9567
9568 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellFont( const wxFont& font )
9569 {
9570 m_defaultCellAttr->SetFont(font);
9571 }
9572
9573 // For editors and renderers the type registry takes precedence over the
9574 // default attr, so we need to register the new editor/renderer for the string
9575 // data type in order to make setting a default editor/renderer appear to
9576 // work correctly.
9577
9578 void wxGrid::SetDefaultRenderer(wxGridCellRenderer *renderer)
9579 {
9580 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
9581 renderer,
9582 GetDefaultEditorForType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING));
9583 }
9584
9585 void wxGrid::SetDefaultEditor(wxGridCellEditor *editor)
9586 {
9587 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
9588 GetDefaultRendererForType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING),
9589 editor);
9590 }
9591
9592 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9593 // access to the default attributes
9594 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9595
9596 wxColour wxGrid::GetDefaultCellBackgroundColour() const
9597 {
9598 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetBackgroundColour();
9599 }
9600
9601 wxColour wxGrid::GetDefaultCellTextColour() const
9602 {
9603 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetTextColour();
9604 }
9605
9606 wxFont wxGrid::GetDefaultCellFont() const
9607 {
9608 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetFont();
9609 }
9610
9611 void wxGrid::GetDefaultCellAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9612 {
9613 m_defaultCellAttr->GetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9614 }
9615
9616 bool wxGrid::GetDefaultCellOverflow() const
9617 {
9618 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetOverflow();
9619 }
9620
9621 wxGridCellRenderer *wxGrid::GetDefaultRenderer() const
9622 {
9623 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetRenderer(NULL, 0, 0);
9624 }
9625
9626 wxGridCellEditor *wxGrid::GetDefaultEditor() const
9627 {
9628 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetEditor(NULL, 0, 0);
9629 }
9630
9631 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9632 // access to cell attributes
9633 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9634
9635 wxColour wxGrid::GetCellBackgroundColour(int row, int col) const
9636 {
9637 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9638 wxColour colour = attr->GetBackgroundColour();
9639 attr->DecRef();
9640
9641 return colour;
9642 }
9643
9644 wxColour wxGrid::GetCellTextColour( int row, int col ) const
9645 {
9646 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9647 wxColour colour = attr->GetTextColour();
9648 attr->DecRef();
9649
9650 return colour;
9651 }
9652
9653 wxFont wxGrid::GetCellFont( int row, int col ) const
9654 {
9655 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9656 wxFont font = attr->GetFont();
9657 attr->DecRef();
9658
9659 return font;
9660 }
9661
9662 void wxGrid::GetCellAlignment( int row, int col, int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9663 {
9664 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9665 attr->GetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9666 attr->DecRef();
9667 }
9668
9669 bool wxGrid::GetCellOverflow( int row, int col ) const
9670 {
9671 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9672 bool allow = attr->GetOverflow();
9673 attr->DecRef();
9674
9675 return allow;
9676 }
9677
9678 void wxGrid::GetCellSize( int row, int col, int *num_rows, int *num_cols ) const
9679 {
9680 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9681 attr->GetSize( num_rows, num_cols );
9682 attr->DecRef();
9683 }
9684
9685 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGrid::GetCellRenderer(int row, int col) const
9686 {
9687 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9688 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
9689 attr->DecRef();
9690
9691 return renderer;
9692 }
9693
9694 wxGridCellEditor* wxGrid::GetCellEditor(int row, int col) const
9695 {
9696 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9697 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
9698 attr->DecRef();
9699
9700 return editor;
9701 }
9702
9703 bool wxGrid::IsReadOnly(int row, int col) const
9704 {
9705 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9706 bool isReadOnly = attr->IsReadOnly();
9707 attr->DecRef();
9708
9709 return isReadOnly;
9710 }
9711
9712 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9713 // attribute support: cache, automatic provider creation, ...
9714 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9715
9716 bool wxGrid::CanHaveAttributes() const
9717 {
9718 if ( !m_table )
9719 {
9720 return false;
9721 }
9722
9723 return m_table->CanHaveAttributes();
9724 }
9725
9726 void wxGrid::ClearAttrCache()
9727 {
9728 if ( m_attrCache.row != -1 )
9729 {
9730 wxGridCellAttr *oldAttr = m_attrCache.attr;
9731 m_attrCache.attr = NULL;
9732 m_attrCache.row = -1;
9733 // wxSafeDecRec(...) might cause event processing that accesses
9734 // the cached attribute, if one exists (e.g. by deleting the
9735 // editor stored within the attribute). Therefore it is important
9736 // to invalidate the cache before calling wxSafeDecRef!
9737 wxSafeDecRef(oldAttr);
9738 }
9739 }
9740
9741 void wxGrid::CacheAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr) const
9742 {
9743 if ( attr != NULL )
9744 {
9745 wxGrid *self = (wxGrid *)this; // const_cast
9746
9747 self->ClearAttrCache();
9748 self->m_attrCache.row = row;
9749 self->m_attrCache.col = col;
9750 self->m_attrCache.attr = attr;
9751 wxSafeIncRef(attr);
9752 }
9753 }
9754
9755 bool wxGrid::LookupAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr **attr) const
9756 {
9757 if ( row == m_attrCache.row && col == m_attrCache.col )
9758 {
9759 *attr = m_attrCache.attr;
9760 wxSafeIncRef(m_attrCache.attr);
9761
9762 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
9763 gs_nAttrCacheHits++;
9764 #endif
9765
9766 return true;
9767 }
9768 else
9769 {
9770 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
9771 gs_nAttrCacheMisses++;
9772 #endif
9773
9774 return false;
9775 }
9776 }
9777
9778 wxGridCellAttr *wxGrid::GetCellAttr(int row, int col) const
9779 {
9780 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
9781 // Additional test to avoid looking at the cache e.g. for
9782 // wxNoCellCoords, as this will confuse memory management.
9783 if ( row >= 0 )
9784 {
9785 if ( !LookupAttr(row, col, &attr) )
9786 {
9787 attr = m_table ? m_table->GetAttr(row, col, wxGridCellAttr::Any)
9788 : NULL;
9789 CacheAttr(row, col, attr);
9790 }
9791 }
9792
9793 if (attr)
9794 {
9795 attr->SetDefAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
9796 }
9797 else
9798 {
9799 attr = m_defaultCellAttr;
9800 attr->IncRef();
9801 }
9802
9803 return attr;
9804 }
9805
9806 wxGridCellAttr *wxGrid::GetOrCreateCellAttr(int row, int col) const
9807 {
9808 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
9809 bool canHave = ((wxGrid*)this)->CanHaveAttributes();
9810
9811 wxCHECK_MSG( canHave, attr, _T("Cell attributes not allowed"));
9812 wxCHECK_MSG( m_table, attr, _T("must have a table") );
9813
9814 attr = m_table->GetAttr(row, col, wxGridCellAttr::Cell);
9815 if ( !attr )
9816 {
9817 attr = new wxGridCellAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
9818
9819 // artificially inc the ref count to match DecRef() in caller
9820 attr->IncRef();
9821 m_table->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
9822 }
9823
9824 return attr;
9825 }
9826
9827 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9828 // setting column attributes (wrappers around SetColAttr)
9829 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9830
9831 void wxGrid::SetColFormatBool(int col)
9832 {
9833 SetColFormatCustom(col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL);
9834 }
9835
9836 void wxGrid::SetColFormatNumber(int col)
9837 {
9838 SetColFormatCustom(col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER);
9839 }
9840
9841 void wxGrid::SetColFormatFloat(int col, int width, int precision)
9842 {
9843 wxString typeName = wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT;
9844 if ( (width != -1) || (precision != -1) )
9845 {
9846 typeName << _T(':') << width << _T(',') << precision;
9847 }
9848
9849 SetColFormatCustom(col, typeName);
9850 }
9851
9852 void wxGrid::SetColFormatCustom(int col, const wxString& typeName)
9853 {
9854 wxGridCellAttr *attr = m_table->GetAttr(-1, col, wxGridCellAttr::Col );
9855 if (!attr)
9856 attr = new wxGridCellAttr;
9857 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = GetDefaultRendererForType(typeName);
9858 attr->SetRenderer(renderer);
9859 wxGridCellEditor *editor = GetDefaultEditorForType(typeName);
9860 attr->SetEditor(editor);
9861
9862 SetColAttr(col, attr);
9863
9864 }
9865
9866 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9867 // setting cell attributes: this is forwarded to the table
9868 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9869
9870 void wxGrid::SetAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
9871 {
9872 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9873 {
9874 m_table->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
9875 ClearAttrCache();
9876 }
9877 else
9878 {
9879 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
9880 }
9881 }
9882
9883 void wxGrid::SetRowAttr(int row, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
9884 {
9885 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9886 {
9887 m_table->SetRowAttr(attr, row);
9888 ClearAttrCache();
9889 }
9890 else
9891 {
9892 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
9893 }
9894 }
9895
9896 void wxGrid::SetColAttr(int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
9897 {
9898 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9899 {
9900 m_table->SetColAttr(attr, col);
9901 ClearAttrCache();
9902 }
9903 else
9904 {
9905 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
9906 }
9907 }
9908
9909 void wxGrid::SetCellBackgroundColour( int row, int col, const wxColour& colour )
9910 {
9911 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9912 {
9913 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9914 attr->SetBackgroundColour(colour);
9915 attr->DecRef();
9916 }
9917 }
9918
9919 void wxGrid::SetCellTextColour( int row, int col, const wxColour& colour )
9920 {
9921 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9922 {
9923 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9924 attr->SetTextColour(colour);
9925 attr->DecRef();
9926 }
9927 }
9928
9929 void wxGrid::SetCellFont( int row, int col, const wxFont& font )
9930 {
9931 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9932 {
9933 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9934 attr->SetFont(font);
9935 attr->DecRef();
9936 }
9937 }
9938
9939 void wxGrid::SetCellAlignment( int row, int col, int horiz, int vert )
9940 {
9941 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9942 {
9943 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9944 attr->SetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9945 attr->DecRef();
9946 }
9947 }
9948
9949 void wxGrid::SetCellOverflow( int row, int col, bool allow )
9950 {
9951 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9952 {
9953 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9954 attr->SetOverflow(allow);
9955 attr->DecRef();
9956 }
9957 }
9958
9959 void wxGrid::SetCellSize( int row, int col, int num_rows, int num_cols )
9960 {
9961 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
9962 {
9963 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
9964
9965 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
9966 attr->GetSize(&cell_rows, &cell_cols);
9967 attr->SetSize(num_rows, num_cols);
9968 attr->DecRef();
9969
9970 // Cannot set the size of a cell to 0 or negative values
9971 // While it is perfectly legal to do that, this function cannot
9972 // handle all the possibilies, do it by hand by getting the CellAttr.
9973 // You can only set the size of a cell to 1,1 or greater with this fn
9974 wxASSERT_MSG( !((cell_rows < 1) || (cell_cols < 1)),
9975 wxT("wxGrid::SetCellSize setting cell size that is already part of another cell"));
9976 wxASSERT_MSG( !((num_rows < 1) || (num_cols < 1)),
9977 wxT("wxGrid::SetCellSize setting cell size to < 1"));
9978
9979 // if this was already a multicell then "turn off" the other cells first
9980 if ((cell_rows > 1) || (cell_cols > 1))
9981 {
9982 int i, j;
9983 for (j=row; j < row + cell_rows; j++)
9984 {
9985 for (i=col; i < col + cell_cols; i++)
9986 {
9987 if ((i != col) || (j != row))
9988 {
9989 wxGridCellAttr *attr_stub = GetOrCreateCellAttr(j, i);
9990 attr_stub->SetSize( 1, 1 );
9991 attr_stub->DecRef();
9992 }
9993 }
9994 }
9995 }
9996
9997 // mark the cells that will be covered by this cell to
9998 // negative or zero values to point back at this cell
9999 if (((num_rows > 1) || (num_cols > 1)) && (num_rows >= 1) && (num_cols >= 1))
10000 {
10001 int i, j;
10002 for (j=row; j < row + num_rows; j++)
10003 {
10004 for (i=col; i < col + num_cols; i++)
10005 {
10006 if ((i != col) || (j != row))
10007 {
10008 wxGridCellAttr *attr_stub = GetOrCreateCellAttr(j, i);
10009 attr_stub->SetSize( row - j, col - i );
10010 attr_stub->DecRef();
10011 }
10012 }
10013 }
10014 }
10015 }
10016 }
10017
10018 void wxGrid::SetCellRenderer(int row, int col, wxGridCellRenderer *renderer)
10019 {
10020 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10021 {
10022 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10023 attr->SetRenderer(renderer);
10024 attr->DecRef();
10025 }
10026 }
10027
10028 void wxGrid::SetCellEditor(int row, int col, wxGridCellEditor* editor)
10029 {
10030 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10031 {
10032 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10033 attr->SetEditor(editor);
10034 attr->DecRef();
10035 }
10036 }
10037
10038 void wxGrid::SetReadOnly(int row, int col, bool isReadOnly)
10039 {
10040 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10041 {
10042 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10043 attr->SetReadOnly(isReadOnly);
10044 attr->DecRef();
10045 }
10046 }
10047
10048 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10049 // Data type registration
10050 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10051
10052 void wxGrid::RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
10053 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
10054 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
10055 {
10056 m_typeRegistry->RegisterDataType(typeName, renderer, editor);
10057 }
10058
10059
10060 wxGridCellEditor * wxGrid::GetDefaultEditorForCell(int row, int col) const
10061 {
10062 wxString typeName = m_table->GetTypeName(row, col);
10063 return GetDefaultEditorForType(typeName);
10064 }
10065
10066 wxGridCellRenderer * wxGrid::GetDefaultRendererForCell(int row, int col) const
10067 {
10068 wxString typeName = m_table->GetTypeName(row, col);
10069 return GetDefaultRendererForType(typeName);
10070 }
10071
10072 wxGridCellEditor * wxGrid::GetDefaultEditorForType(const wxString& typeName) const
10073 {
10074 int index = m_typeRegistry->FindOrCloneDataType(typeName);
10075 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
10076 {
10077 wxFAIL_MSG(wxString::Format(wxT("Unknown data type name [%s]"), typeName.c_str()));
10078
10079 return NULL;
10080 }
10081
10082 return m_typeRegistry->GetEditor(index);
10083 }
10084
10085 wxGridCellRenderer * wxGrid::GetDefaultRendererForType(const wxString& typeName) const
10086 {
10087 int index = m_typeRegistry->FindOrCloneDataType(typeName);
10088 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
10089 {
10090 wxFAIL_MSG(wxString::Format(wxT("Unknown data type name [%s]"), typeName.c_str()));
10091
10092 return NULL;
10093 }
10094
10095 return m_typeRegistry->GetRenderer(index);
10096 }
10097
10098 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10099 // row/col size
10100 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10101
10102 void wxGrid::EnableDragRowSize( bool enable )
10103 {
10104 m_canDragRowSize = enable;
10105 }
10106
10107 void wxGrid::EnableDragColSize( bool enable )
10108 {
10109 m_canDragColSize = enable;
10110 }
10111
10112 void wxGrid::EnableDragGridSize( bool enable )
10113 {
10114 m_canDragGridSize = enable;
10115 }
10116
10117 void wxGrid::EnableDragCell( bool enable )
10118 {
10119 m_canDragCell = enable;
10120 }
10121
10122 void wxGrid::SetDefaultRowSize( int height, bool resizeExistingRows )
10123 {
10124 m_defaultRowHeight = wxMax( height, m_minAcceptableRowHeight );
10125
10126 if ( resizeExistingRows )
10127 {
10128 // since we are resizing all rows to the default row size,
10129 // we can simply clear the row heights and row bottoms
10130 // arrays (which also allows us to take advantage of
10131 // some speed optimisations)
10132 m_rowHeights.Empty();
10133 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
10134 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10135 CalcDimensions();
10136 }
10137 }
10138
10139 void wxGrid::SetRowSize( int row, int height )
10140 {
10141 wxCHECK_RET( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows, _T("invalid row index") );
10142
10143 // if < 0 then calculate new height from label
10144 if ( height < 0 )
10145 {
10146 long w, h;
10147 wxArrayString lines;
10148 wxClientDC dc(m_rowLabelWin);
10149 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10150 StringToLines(GetRowLabelValue( row ), lines);
10151 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &w, &h );
10152 //check that it is not less than the minimal height
10153 height = wxMax(h, GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight());
10154 }
10155
10156 // See comment in SetColSize
10157 if ( height < GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight())
10158 return;
10159
10160 if ( m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
10161 {
10162 // need to really create the array
10163 InitRowHeights();
10164 }
10165
10166 int h = wxMax( 0, height );
10167 int diff = h - m_rowHeights[row];
10168
10169 m_rowHeights[row] = h;
10170 for ( int i = row; i < m_numRows; i++ )
10171 {
10172 m_rowBottoms[i] += diff;
10173 }
10174
10175 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10176 CalcDimensions();
10177 }
10178
10179 void wxGrid::SetDefaultColSize( int width, bool resizeExistingCols )
10180 {
10181 // we dont allow zero default column width
10182 m_defaultColWidth = wxMax( wxMax( width, m_minAcceptableColWidth ), 1 );
10183
10184 if ( resizeExistingCols )
10185 {
10186 // since we are resizing all columns to the default column size,
10187 // we can simply clear the col widths and col rights
10188 // arrays (which also allows us to take advantage of
10189 // some speed optimisations)
10190 m_colWidths.Empty();
10191 m_colRights.Empty();
10192 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10193 CalcDimensions();
10194 }
10195 }
10196
10197 void wxGrid::SetColSize( int col, int width )
10198 {
10199 wxCHECK_RET( col >= 0 && col < m_numCols, _T("invalid column index") );
10200
10201 // if < 0 then calculate new width from label
10202 if ( width < 0 )
10203 {
10204 long w, h;
10205 wxArrayString lines;
10206 wxClientDC dc(m_colLabelWin);
10207 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10208 StringToLines(GetColLabelValue(col), lines);
10209 if ( GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxHORIZONTAL )
10210 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &w, &h );
10211 else
10212 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &h, &w );
10213 width = w + 6;
10214 //check that it is not less than the minimal width
10215 width = wxMax(width, GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth());
10216 }
10217
10218 // should we check that it's bigger than GetColMinimalWidth(col) here?
10219 // (VZ)
10220 // No, because it is reasonable to assume the library user know's
10221 // what he is doing. However we should test against the weaker
10222 // constraint of minimalAcceptableWidth, as this breaks rendering
10223 //
10224 // This test then fixes sf.net bug #645734
10225
10226 if ( width < GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth() )
10227 return;
10228
10229 if ( m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
10230 {
10231 // need to really create the array
10232 InitColWidths();
10233 }
10234
10235 int w = wxMax( 0, width );
10236 int diff = w - m_colWidths[col];
10237 m_colWidths[col] = w;
10238
10239 for ( int colPos = GetColPos(col); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
10240 {
10241 m_colRights[GetColAt(colPos)] += diff;
10242 }
10243
10244 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10245 CalcDimensions();
10246 }
10247
10248 void wxGrid::SetColMinimalWidth( int col, int width )
10249 {
10250 if (width > GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth())
10251 {
10252 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)col;
10253 m_colMinWidths[key] = width;
10254 }
10255 }
10256
10257 void wxGrid::SetRowMinimalHeight( int row, int width )
10258 {
10259 if (width > GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight())
10260 {
10261 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)row;
10262 m_rowMinHeights[key] = width;
10263 }
10264 }
10265
10266 int wxGrid::GetColMinimalWidth(int col) const
10267 {
10268 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)col;
10269 wxLongToLongHashMap::const_iterator it = m_colMinWidths.find(key);
10270
10271 return it != m_colMinWidths.end() ? (int)it->second : m_minAcceptableColWidth;
10272 }
10273
10274 int wxGrid::GetRowMinimalHeight(int row) const
10275 {
10276 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)row;
10277 wxLongToLongHashMap::const_iterator it = m_rowMinHeights.find(key);
10278
10279 return it != m_rowMinHeights.end() ? (int)it->second : m_minAcceptableRowHeight;
10280 }
10281
10282 void wxGrid::SetColMinimalAcceptableWidth( int width )
10283 {
10284 // We do allow a width of 0 since this gives us
10285 // an easy way to temporarily hiding columns.
10286 if ( width >= 0 )
10287 m_minAcceptableColWidth = width;
10288 }
10289
10290 void wxGrid::SetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight( int height )
10291 {
10292 // We do allow a height of 0 since this gives us
10293 // an easy way to temporarily hiding rows.
10294 if ( height >= 0 )
10295 m_minAcceptableRowHeight = height;
10296 }
10297
10298 int wxGrid::GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth() const
10299 {
10300 return m_minAcceptableColWidth;
10301 }
10302
10303 int wxGrid::GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight() const
10304 {
10305 return m_minAcceptableRowHeight;
10306 }
10307
10308 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10309 // auto sizing
10310 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10311
10312 void
10313 wxGrid::AutoSizeColOrRow(int colOrRow, bool setAsMin, wxGridDirection direction)
10314 {
10315 const bool column = direction == wxGRID_COLUMN;
10316
10317 wxClientDC dc(m_gridWin);
10318
10319 // cancel editing of cell
10320 HideCellEditControl();
10321 SaveEditControlValue();
10322
10323 // init both of them to avoid compiler warnings, even if we only need one
10324 int row = -1,
10325 col = -1;
10326 if ( column )
10327 col = colOrRow;
10328 else
10329 row = colOrRow;
10330
10331 wxCoord extent, extentMax = 0;
10332 int max = column ? m_numRows : m_numCols;
10333 for ( int rowOrCol = 0; rowOrCol < max; rowOrCol++ )
10334 {
10335 if ( column )
10336 row = rowOrCol;
10337 else
10338 col = rowOrCol;
10339
10340 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
10341 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
10342 if ( renderer )
10343 {
10344 wxSize size = renderer->GetBestSize(*this, *attr, dc, row, col);
10345 extent = column ? size.x : size.y;
10346 if ( extent > extentMax )
10347 extentMax = extent;
10348
10349 renderer->DecRef();
10350 }
10351
10352 attr->DecRef();
10353 }
10354
10355 // now also compare with the column label extent
10356 wxCoord w, h;
10357 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
10358
10359 if ( column )
10360 {
10361 dc.GetMultiLineTextExtent( GetColLabelValue(col), &w, &h );
10362 if ( GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxVERTICAL )
10363 w = h;
10364 }
10365 else
10366 dc.GetMultiLineTextExtent( GetRowLabelValue(row), &w, &h );
10367
10368 extent = column ? w : h;
10369 if ( extent > extentMax )
10370 extentMax = extent;
10371
10372 if ( !extentMax )
10373 {
10374 // empty column - give default extent (notice that if extentMax is less
10375 // than default extent but != 0, it's OK)
10376 extentMax = column ? m_defaultColWidth : m_defaultRowHeight;
10377 }
10378 else
10379 {
10380 if ( column )
10381 // leave some space around text
10382 extentMax += 10;
10383 else
10384 extentMax += 6;
10385 }
10386
10387 if ( column )
10388 {
10389 // Ensure automatic width is not less than minimal width. See the
10390 // comment in SetColSize() for explanation of why this isn't done
10391 // in SetColSize().
10392 if ( !setAsMin )
10393 extentMax = wxMax(extentMax, GetColMinimalWidth(col));
10394
10395 SetColSize( col, extentMax );
10396 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10397 {
10398 int cw, ch, dummy;
10399 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
10400 wxRect rect ( CellToRect( 0, col ) );
10401 rect.y = 0;
10402 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &dummy);
10403 rect.width = cw - rect.x;
10404 rect.height = m_colLabelHeight;
10405 m_colLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
10406 }
10407 }
10408 else
10409 {
10410 // Ensure automatic width is not less than minimal height. See the
10411 // comment in SetColSize() for explanation of why this isn't done
10412 // in SetRowSize().
10413 if ( !setAsMin )
10414 extentMax = wxMax(extentMax, GetRowMinimalHeight(row));
10415
10416 SetRowSize(row, extentMax);
10417 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10418 {
10419 int cw, ch, dummy;
10420 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
10421 wxRect rect( CellToRect( row, 0 ) );
10422 rect.x = 0;
10423 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
10424 rect.width = m_rowLabelWidth;
10425 rect.height = ch - rect.y;
10426 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
10427 }
10428 }
10429
10430 if ( setAsMin )
10431 {
10432 if ( column )
10433 SetColMinimalWidth(col, extentMax);
10434 else
10435 SetRowMinimalHeight(row, extentMax);
10436 }
10437 }
10438
10439 wxCoord wxGrid::CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGridDirection direction)
10440 {
10441 // calculate size for the rows or columns?
10442 const bool calcRows = direction == wxGRID_ROW;
10443
10444 wxClientDC dc(calcRows ? GetGridRowLabelWindow()
10445 : GetGridColLabelWindow());
10446 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10447
10448 // which dimension should we take into account for calculations?
10449 //
10450 // for columns, the text can be only horizontal so it's easy but for rows
10451 // we also have to take into account the text orientation
10452 const bool
10453 useWidth = calcRows || (GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxVERTICAL);
10454
10455 wxArrayString lines;
10456 wxCoord extentMax = 0;
10457
10458 const int numRowsOrCols = calcRows ? m_numRows : m_numCols;
10459 for ( int rowOrCol = 0; rowOrCol < numRowsOrCols; rowOrCol++ )
10460 {
10461 lines.Clear();
10462
10463 wxString label = calcRows ? GetRowLabelValue(rowOrCol)
10464 : GetColLabelValue(rowOrCol);
10465 StringToLines(label, lines);
10466
10467 long w, h;
10468 GetTextBoxSize(dc, lines, &w, &h);
10469
10470 const wxCoord extent = useWidth ? w : h;
10471 if ( extent > extentMax )
10472 extentMax = extent;
10473 }
10474
10475 if ( !extentMax )
10476 {
10477 // empty column - give default extent (notice that if extentMax is less
10478 // than default extent but != 0, it's OK)
10479 extentMax = calcRows ? GetDefaultRowLabelSize()
10480 : GetDefaultColLabelSize();
10481 }
10482
10483 // leave some space around text (taken from AutoSizeColOrRow)
10484 if ( calcRows )
10485 extentMax += 10;
10486 else
10487 extentMax += 6;
10488
10489 return extentMax;
10490 }
10491
10492 int wxGrid::SetOrCalcColumnSizes(bool calcOnly, bool setAsMin)
10493 {
10494 int width = m_rowLabelWidth;
10495
10496 wxGridUpdateLocker locker;
10497 if(!calcOnly)
10498 locker.Create(this);
10499
10500 for ( int col = 0; col < m_numCols; col++ )
10501 {
10502 if ( !calcOnly )
10503 AutoSizeColumn(col, setAsMin);
10504
10505 width += GetColWidth(col);
10506 }
10507
10508 return width;
10509 }
10510
10511 int wxGrid::SetOrCalcRowSizes(bool calcOnly, bool setAsMin)
10512 {
10513 int height = m_colLabelHeight;
10514
10515 wxGridUpdateLocker locker;
10516 if(!calcOnly)
10517 locker.Create(this);
10518
10519 for ( int row = 0; row < m_numRows; row++ )
10520 {
10521 if ( !calcOnly )
10522 AutoSizeRow(row, setAsMin);
10523
10524 height += GetRowHeight(row);
10525 }
10526
10527 return height;
10528 }
10529
10530 void wxGrid::AutoSize()
10531 {
10532 wxGridUpdateLocker locker(this);
10533
10534 wxSize size(SetOrCalcColumnSizes(false) - m_rowLabelWidth + m_extraWidth,
10535 SetOrCalcRowSizes(false) - m_colLabelHeight + m_extraHeight);
10536
10537 // we know that we're not going to have scrollbars so disable them now to
10538 // avoid trouble in SetClientSize() which can otherwise set the correct
10539 // client size but also leave space for (not needed any more) scrollbars
10540 SetScrollbars(0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, true);
10541
10542 // restore the scroll rate parameters overwritten by SetScrollbars()
10543 SetScrollRate(m_scrollLineX, m_scrollLineY);
10544
10545 SetClientSize(size.x + m_rowLabelWidth, size.y + m_colLabelHeight);
10546 }
10547
10548 void wxGrid::AutoSizeRowLabelSize( int row )
10549 {
10550 // Hide the edit control, so it
10551 // won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
10552 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
10553 {
10554 HideCellEditControl();
10555 SaveEditControlValue();
10556 }
10557
10558 // autosize row height depending on label text
10559 SetRowSize(row, -1);
10560 ForceRefresh();
10561 }
10562
10563 void wxGrid::AutoSizeColLabelSize( int col )
10564 {
10565 // Hide the edit control, so it
10566 // won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
10567 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
10568 {
10569 HideCellEditControl();
10570 SaveEditControlValue();
10571 }
10572
10573 // autosize column width depending on label text
10574 SetColSize(col, -1);
10575 ForceRefresh();
10576 }
10577
10578 wxSize wxGrid::DoGetBestSize() const
10579 {
10580 wxGrid *self = (wxGrid *)this; // const_cast
10581
10582 // we do the same as in AutoSize() here with the exception that we don't
10583 // change the column/row sizes, only calculate them
10584 wxSize size(self->SetOrCalcColumnSizes(true) - m_rowLabelWidth + m_extraWidth,
10585 self->SetOrCalcRowSizes(true) - m_colLabelHeight + m_extraHeight);
10586
10587 // NOTE: This size should be cached, but first we need to add calls to
10588 // InvalidateBestSize everywhere that could change the results of this
10589 // calculation.
10590 // CacheBestSize(size);
10591
10592 return wxSize(size.x + m_rowLabelWidth, size.y + m_colLabelHeight)
10593 + GetWindowBorderSize();
10594 }
10595
10596 void wxGrid::Fit()
10597 {
10598 AutoSize();
10599 }
10600
10601 wxPen& wxGrid::GetDividerPen() const
10602 {
10603 return wxNullPen;
10604 }
10605
10606 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10607 // cell value accessor functions
10608 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10609
10610 void wxGrid::SetCellValue( int row, int col, const wxString& s )
10611 {
10612 if ( m_table )
10613 {
10614 m_table->SetValue( row, col, s );
10615 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10616 {
10617 int dummy;
10618 wxRect rect( CellToRect( row, col ) );
10619 rect.x = 0;
10620 rect.width = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
10621 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
10622 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
10623 }
10624
10625 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() == row &&
10626 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() == col &&
10627 IsCellEditControlShown())
10628 // Note: If we are using IsCellEditControlEnabled,
10629 // this interacts badly with calling SetCellValue from
10630 // an EVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE handler.
10631 {
10632 HideCellEditControl();
10633 ShowCellEditControl(); // will reread data from table
10634 }
10635 }
10636 }
10637
10638 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10639 // block, row and column selection
10640 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10641
10642 void wxGrid::SelectRow( int row, bool addToSelected )
10643 {
10644 if ( !m_selection )
10645 return;
10646
10647 if ( !addToSelected )
10648 ClearSelection();
10649
10650 m_selection->SelectRow(row);
10651 }
10652
10653 void wxGrid::SelectCol( int col, bool addToSelected )
10654 {
10655 if ( !m_selection )
10656 return;
10657
10658 if ( !addToSelected )
10659 ClearSelection();
10660
10661 m_selection->SelectCol(col);
10662 }
10663
10664 void wxGrid::SelectBlock(int topRow, int leftCol, int bottomRow, int rightCol,
10665 bool addToSelected)
10666 {
10667 if ( !m_selection )
10668 return;
10669
10670 if ( !addToSelected )
10671 ClearSelection();
10672
10673 m_selection->SelectBlock(topRow, leftCol, bottomRow, rightCol);
10674 }
10675
10676 void wxGrid::SelectAll()
10677 {
10678 if ( m_numRows > 0 && m_numCols > 0 )
10679 {
10680 if ( m_selection )
10681 m_selection->SelectBlock( 0, 0, m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1 );
10682 }
10683 }
10684
10685 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10686 // cell, row and col deselection
10687 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10688
10689 void wxGrid::DeselectLine(int line, const wxGridOperations& oper)
10690 {
10691 if ( !m_selection )
10692 return;
10693
10694 const wxGridSelectionModes mode = m_selection->GetSelectionMode();
10695 if ( mode == oper.GetSelectionMode() )
10696 {
10697 const wxGridCellCoords c(oper.MakeCoords(line, 0));
10698 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(c) )
10699 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(c);
10700 }
10701 else if ( mode != oper.Dual().GetSelectionMode() )
10702 {
10703 const int nOther = oper.Dual().GetNumberOfLines(this);
10704 for ( int i = 0; i < nOther; i++ )
10705 {
10706 const wxGridCellCoords c(oper.MakeCoords(line, i));
10707 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(c) )
10708 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(c);
10709 }
10710 }
10711 //else: can only select orthogonal lines so no lines in this direction
10712 // could have been selected anyhow
10713 }
10714
10715 void wxGrid::DeselectRow(int row)
10716 {
10717 DeselectLine(row, wxGridRowOperations());
10718 }
10719
10720 void wxGrid::DeselectCol(int col)
10721 {
10722 DeselectLine(col, wxGridColumnOperations());
10723 }
10724
10725 void wxGrid::DeselectCell( int row, int col )
10726 {
10727 if ( m_selection && m_selection->IsInSelection(row, col) )
10728 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(row, col);
10729 }
10730
10731 bool wxGrid::IsSelection() const
10732 {
10733 return ( m_selection && (m_selection->IsSelection() ||
10734 ( m_selectedBlockTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
10735 m_selectedBlockBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords) ) );
10736 }
10737
10738 bool wxGrid::IsInSelection( int row, int col ) const
10739 {
10740 return ( m_selection && (m_selection->IsInSelection( row, col ) ||
10741 ( row >= m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetRow() &&
10742 col >= m_selectedBlockTopLeft.GetCol() &&
10743 row <= m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetRow() &&
10744 col <= m_selectedBlockBottomRight.GetCol() )) );
10745 }
10746
10747 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectedCells() const
10748 {
10749 if (!m_selection)
10750 {
10751 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
10752 return a;
10753 }
10754
10755 return m_selection->m_cellSelection;
10756 }
10757
10758 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectionBlockTopLeft() const
10759 {
10760 if (!m_selection)
10761 {
10762 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
10763 return a;
10764 }
10765
10766 return m_selection->m_blockSelectionTopLeft;
10767 }
10768
10769 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectionBlockBottomRight() const
10770 {
10771 if (!m_selection)
10772 {
10773 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
10774 return a;
10775 }
10776
10777 return m_selection->m_blockSelectionBottomRight;
10778 }
10779
10780 wxArrayInt wxGrid::GetSelectedRows() const
10781 {
10782 if (!m_selection)
10783 {
10784 wxArrayInt a;
10785 return a;
10786 }
10787
10788 return m_selection->m_rowSelection;
10789 }
10790
10791 wxArrayInt wxGrid::GetSelectedCols() const
10792 {
10793 if (!m_selection)
10794 {
10795 wxArrayInt a;
10796 return a;
10797 }
10798
10799 return m_selection->m_colSelection;
10800 }
10801
10802 void wxGrid::ClearSelection()
10803 {
10804 wxRect r1 = BlockToDeviceRect(m_selectedBlockTopLeft,
10805 m_selectedBlockBottomRight);
10806 wxRect r2 = BlockToDeviceRect(m_currentCellCoords,
10807 m_selectedBlockCorner);
10808
10809 m_selectedBlockTopLeft =
10810 m_selectedBlockBottomRight =
10811 m_selectedBlockCorner = wxGridNoCellCoords;
10812
10813 Refresh( false, &r1 );
10814 Refresh( false, &r2 );
10815
10816 if ( m_selection )
10817 m_selection->ClearSelection();
10818 }
10819
10820 // This function returns the rectangle that encloses the given block
10821 // in device coords clipped to the client size of the grid window.
10822 //
10823 wxRect wxGrid::BlockToDeviceRect( const wxGridCellCoords& topLeft,
10824 const wxGridCellCoords& bottomRight ) const
10825 {
10826 wxRect resultRect;
10827 wxRect tempCellRect = CellToRect(topLeft);
10828 if ( tempCellRect != wxGridNoCellRect )
10829 {
10830 resultRect = tempCellRect;
10831 }
10832 else
10833 {
10834 resultRect = wxRect(0, 0, 0, 0);
10835 }
10836
10837 tempCellRect = CellToRect(bottomRight);
10838 if ( tempCellRect != wxGridNoCellRect )
10839 {
10840 resultRect += tempCellRect;
10841 }
10842 else
10843 {
10844 // If both inputs were "wxGridNoCellRect," then there's nothing to do.
10845 return wxGridNoCellRect;
10846 }
10847
10848 // Ensure that left/right and top/bottom pairs are in order.
10849 int left = resultRect.GetLeft();
10850 int top = resultRect.GetTop();
10851 int right = resultRect.GetRight();
10852 int bottom = resultRect.GetBottom();
10853
10854 int leftCol = topLeft.GetCol();
10855 int topRow = topLeft.GetRow();
10856 int rightCol = bottomRight.GetCol();
10857 int bottomRow = bottomRight.GetRow();
10858
10859 if (left > right)
10860 {
10861 int tmp = left;
10862 left = right;
10863 right = tmp;
10864
10865 tmp = leftCol;
10866 leftCol = rightCol;
10867 rightCol = tmp;
10868 }
10869
10870 if (top > bottom)
10871 {
10872 int tmp = top;
10873 top = bottom;
10874 bottom = tmp;
10875
10876 tmp = topRow;
10877 topRow = bottomRow;
10878 bottomRow = tmp;
10879 }
10880
10881 // The following loop is ONLY necessary to detect and handle merged cells.
10882 int cw, ch;
10883 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
10884
10885 // Get the origin coordinates: notice that they will be negative if the
10886 // grid is scrolled downwards/to the right.
10887 int gridOriginX = 0;
10888 int gridOriginY = 0;
10889 CalcScrolledPosition(gridOriginX, gridOriginY, &gridOriginX, &gridOriginY);
10890
10891 int onScreenLeftmostCol = internalXToCol(-gridOriginX);
10892 int onScreenUppermostRow = internalYToRow(-gridOriginY);
10893
10894 int onScreenRightmostCol = internalXToCol(-gridOriginX + cw);
10895 int onScreenBottommostRow = internalYToRow(-gridOriginY + ch);
10896
10897 // Bound our loop so that we only examine the portion of the selected block
10898 // that is shown on screen. Therefore, we compare the Top-Left block values
10899 // to the Top-Left screen values, and the Bottom-Right block values to the
10900 // Bottom-Right screen values, choosing appropriately.
10901 const int visibleTopRow = wxMax(topRow, onScreenUppermostRow);
10902 const int visibleBottomRow = wxMin(bottomRow, onScreenBottommostRow);
10903 const int visibleLeftCol = wxMax(leftCol, onScreenLeftmostCol);
10904 const int visibleRightCol = wxMin(rightCol, onScreenRightmostCol);
10905
10906 for ( int j = visibleTopRow; j <= visibleBottomRow; j++ )
10907 {
10908 for ( int i = visibleLeftCol; i <= visibleRightCol; i++ )
10909 {
10910 if ( (j == visibleTopRow) || (j == visibleBottomRow) ||
10911 (i == visibleLeftCol) || (i == visibleRightCol) )
10912 {
10913 tempCellRect = CellToRect( j, i );
10914
10915 if (tempCellRect.x < left)
10916 left = tempCellRect.x;
10917 if (tempCellRect.y < top)
10918 top = tempCellRect.y;
10919 if (tempCellRect.x + tempCellRect.width > right)
10920 right = tempCellRect.x + tempCellRect.width;
10921 if (tempCellRect.y + tempCellRect.height > bottom)
10922 bottom = tempCellRect.y + tempCellRect.height;
10923 }
10924 else
10925 {
10926 i = visibleRightCol; // jump over inner cells.
10927 }
10928 }
10929 }
10930
10931 // Convert to scrolled coords
10932 CalcScrolledPosition( left, top, &left, &top );
10933 CalcScrolledPosition( right, bottom, &right, &bottom );
10934
10935 if (right < 0 || bottom < 0 || left > cw || top > ch)
10936 return wxRect(0,0,0,0);
10937
10938 resultRect.SetLeft( wxMax(0, left) );
10939 resultRect.SetTop( wxMax(0, top) );
10940 resultRect.SetRight( wxMin(cw, right) );
10941 resultRect.SetBottom( wxMin(ch, bottom) );
10942
10943 return resultRect;
10944 }
10945
10946 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10947 // drop target
10948 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10949
10950 #if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
10951
10952 // this allow setting drop target directly on wxGrid
10953 void wxGrid::SetDropTarget(wxDropTarget *dropTarget)
10954 {
10955 GetGridWindow()->SetDropTarget(dropTarget);
10956 }
10957
10958 #endif // wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
10959
10960 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10961 // grid event classes
10962 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10963
10964 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
10965
10966 wxGridEvent::wxGridEvent( int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
10967 int row, int col, int x, int y, bool sel,
10968 bool control, bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
10969 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id ),
10970 wxKeyboardState(control, shift, alt, meta)
10971 {
10972 Init(row, col, x, y, sel);
10973
10974 SetEventObject(obj);
10975 }
10976
10977 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridSizeEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
10978
10979 wxGridSizeEvent::wxGridSizeEvent( int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
10980 int rowOrCol, int x, int y,
10981 bool control, bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
10982 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id ),
10983 wxKeyboardState(control, shift, alt, meta)
10984 {
10985 Init(rowOrCol, x, y);
10986
10987 SetEventObject(obj);
10988 }
10989
10990
10991 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridRangeSelectEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
10992
10993 wxGridRangeSelectEvent::wxGridRangeSelectEvent(int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
10994 const wxGridCellCoords& topLeft,
10995 const wxGridCellCoords& bottomRight,
10996 bool sel, bool control,
10997 bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
10998 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id ),
10999 wxKeyboardState(control, shift, alt, meta)
11000 {
11001 Init(topLeft, bottomRight, sel);
11002
11003 SetEventObject(obj);
11004 }
11005
11006
11007 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridEditorCreatedEvent, wxCommandEvent)
11008
11009 wxGridEditorCreatedEvent::wxGridEditorCreatedEvent(int id, wxEventType type,
11010 wxObject* obj, int row,
11011 int col, wxControl* ctrl)
11012 : wxCommandEvent(type, id)
11013 {
11014 SetEventObject(obj);
11015 m_row = row;
11016 m_col = col;
11017 m_ctrl = ctrl;
11018 }
11019
11020 #endif // wxUSE_GRID